target: avoid polling during 'resumed' event handler
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex zy1000
302 @cindex printer port
303 @cindex USB Adapter
304 @cindex RTCK
305
306 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
307 an adapter .... [snip]
308
309 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
310 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
311 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
312 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
313 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
314 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
315 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
316
317
318 @section Choosing a Dongle
319
320 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
321
322 @enumerate
323 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
324 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
325 other ways to communicate with target devices.
326 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
327 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
328 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
329 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
330 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
331 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
332 Ethernet port needed?
333 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
334 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
335 @end enumerate
336
337 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
338
339 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
340 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
341 running on the developer's host computer.
342 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
343 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
344 IP address assigned to the probe.
345 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
346 OpenOCD debugger.
347 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
348 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
349 the target.
350 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
351 to power cycle the target remotely.
352
353 For more information, visit:
354
355 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
356
357 @section USB FT2232 Based
358
359 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
360 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
361 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
362 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
363 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
364 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
365 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
366 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
367 clocking.)
368
369 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
370 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
371 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
372 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
373 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
374
375 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
376 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
377
378 @itemize @bullet
379 @item @b{usbjtag}
380 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
381 @item @b{jtagkey}
382 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
383 @item @b{jtagkey2}
384 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
385 @item @b{oocdlink}
386 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
387 @item @b{signalyzer}
388 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
389 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
390 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
391 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
392 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
393 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
394 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
395 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
396 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
397 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
398 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
399 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
400 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
401 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
402 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
403 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
404 @item @b{turtelizer2}
405 @* See:
406 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
407 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
408 @item @b{comstick}
409 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
410 @item @b{stm32stick}
411 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
412 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
413 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
414 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
415 @item @b{cortino}
416 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
417 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
418 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
419 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
420 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
421 @item @b{opendous}
422 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
423 (OpenHardware).
424 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
425 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
426
427 @item @b{GW16042}
428 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
429 FT2232H-based
430
431 @end itemize
432 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
433
434 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
435 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
436 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
437 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
438 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
439
440 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
441 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
442 (see the section on driver commands).
443
444 @itemize
445 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
446 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
447 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
448 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
449 @end itemize
450
451 @section USB J-Link based
452 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
453 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
454 AT91SAM764 internally.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
458 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
459 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
460 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
461 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
462 @end itemize
463
464 @section USB RLINK based
465 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
466 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
467 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
468
469 @itemize @bullet
470 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
471 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
472 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
473 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
474 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
475 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
476 @end itemize
477
478 @section USB ST-LINK based
479 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
480 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
481
482 @itemize @bullet
483 @item @b{ST-LINK}
484 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
485 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
486 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
487 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
488 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
489 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
490 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
491 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
492 @end itemize
493
494 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
495 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
496 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
497 @itemize @bullet
498 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
499 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
500 @end itemize
501
502 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
503 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
504 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
505 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
506
507 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
508 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
509 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
510 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
511 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
512
513 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
514 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
515 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
516
517 @section USB Other
518 @itemize @bullet
519 @item @b{USBprog}
520 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
521
522 @item @b{USB - Presto}
523 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
524
525 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
526 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
527
528 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
529 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
530
531 @item @b{Buspirate}
532 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
533
534 @item @b{opendous}
535 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
536
537 @item @b{estick}
538 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
539
540 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
541 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
542
543 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
544 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
545 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
546 @end itemize
547
548 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
549
550 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
551 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
552 these on the market.
553
554 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
555 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
556 of USB-based ones.
557
558 @itemize @bullet
559
560 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
561 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
562
563 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
564 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
565 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
566
567 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
569
570 @item @b{Wiggler2}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
572
573 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
574 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
575
576 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
577 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
578
579 @item @b{arm-jtag}
580 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
581
582 @item @b{chameleon}
583 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
584
585 @item @b{Triton}
586 @* Unknown.
587
588 @item @b{Lattice}
589 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
590 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
591
592 @item @b{flashlink}
593 @* From STMicroelectronics;
594 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
595
596 @end itemize
597
598 @section Other...
599 @itemize @bullet
600
601 @item @b{ep93xx}
602 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
603
604 @item @b{at91rm9200}
605 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
606
607 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
608 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
609
610 @item @b{imx_gpio}
611 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
612
613 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
614 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
615 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
616
617 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
618 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
619 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
620 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
621 emulation model of target hardware.
622
623 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
624 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
625
626 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
627 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
628
629 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
630 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
631 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
632
633 @end itemize
634
635 @node About Jim-Tcl
636 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
637 @cindex Jim-Tcl
638 @cindex tcl
639
640 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
641 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
642 command interpreter.
643
644 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
645 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
646 much of anything about Tcl.
647 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
648
649 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
650 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
651 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
652 OpenOCD mailing list.
653
654 @itemize @bullet
655 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
656 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
657 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
658 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
659 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
660 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
661
662 @item @b{Missing Features}
663 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
664 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
665 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
666 enabled in OpenOCD.
667
668 @item @b{Scripts}
669 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
670 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
671 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
672
673 @item @b{Commands}
674 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
675 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
676 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
677 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
678
679 @item @b{Historical Note}
680 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
681 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
682 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
683 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
684
685 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
686 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
687 @end itemize
688
689 @node Running
690 @chapter Running
691 @cindex command line options
692 @cindex logfile
693 @cindex directory search
694
695 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
696 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
697 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
698 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
699 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
700 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
701 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
702
703 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
704 tell it how each debug session should work.
705 The @option{--help} option shows:
706 @verbatim
707 bash$ openocd --help
708
709 --help | -h display this help
710 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
711 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
712 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
713 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
714 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
715 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
716 --command | -c run <command>
717 @end verbatim
718
719 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
720 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
721 To specify one or more different
722 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
723
724 @example
725 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
726 @end example
727
728 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
729 @enumerate
730 @item the current directory,
731 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
732 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
733 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
734 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
735 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
736 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
737 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
738 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
739 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
740 @end enumerate
741 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
742
743 @quotation Note
744 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
745 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
746 @end quotation
747
748 @section Simple setup, no customization
749
750 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
751 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
752 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
753 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
754 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
755
756 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
757 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
758 the server with some variation of one of the following:
759
760 @example
761 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
762 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
763 @end example
764
765 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
766 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
767 If all goes well you'll see output something like
768
769 @example
770 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
771 For bug reports, read
772 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
773 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
774 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
775 @end example
776
777 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
778 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
779 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
780
781 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
782
783 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
784 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
785 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
786 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
787 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
788 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
789 ensure that this always succeeds.
790 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
791 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
792 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
793 and then shut down without acting as a server.
794
795 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
796 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
797 those channels.
798
799 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
800 the @option{-d} option.
801
802 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
803 @option{-c} command line switch.
804
805 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
806 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
807 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
808 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
809 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
810 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
811 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
812
813 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
814 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
815
816 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
817 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
818 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
819 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
820
821 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
822 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
823
824 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
825 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
826 and start the OpenOCD server.
827 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
828 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
829 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
830 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
831
832 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
833
834 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
835 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
836 and a USB cable on the other.
837 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
838 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
839
840 @enumerate
841 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
842 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
843 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
844 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
845 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
846 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
847 debugging host.
848
849 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
850 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
851 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
852 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
853 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
854
855 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
856 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
857 with 1.2 Volt boards.
858
859 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
860 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
861 ways to connect the cable.
862 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
863 Be sure it's firmly connected.
864
865 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
866 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
867 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
868 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
869 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
870 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
871 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
872 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
873
874 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
875 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
876 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
877 but are tedious to set up.
878 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
879 adapter signals to the right board pins.
880
881 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
882 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
883 you are using to run OpenOCD.
884 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
885
886 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
887 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
888 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
889 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
890
891 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
892 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
893 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
894
895 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
896 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
897 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
898 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
899
900 @end enumerate
901
902 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
903 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
904 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
905
906 @section Project Directory
907
908 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
909
910 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
911 single directory for your work with a given board.
912 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
913 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
914 files accessed through semihosting,
915 and for code you upload to the target board.
916 It is also the natural place to write files,
917 such as log files and data you download from the board.
918
919 @section Configuration Basics
920
921 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
922 a variety of ways you can mix them.
923 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
924
925 @itemize
926 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
927 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
928 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
929 @end itemize
930
931 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
932 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
933 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
934
935 @example
936 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
937
938 # GDB can also flash my flash!
939 gdb_memory_map enable
940 gdb_flash_program enable
941
942 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
943 @end example
944
945 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
946
947 @example
948 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
949 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
950 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
951 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
952 @end example
953
954 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
955 each supporting a different development task.
956 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
957 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
958
959 @quotation Important
960 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
961 problems with how it treats variables.
962 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
963 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
964 that can be tested in a later script.
965 @end quotation
966
967 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
968 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
969 to simplify your work.
970
971 @section User Config Files
972 @cindex config file, user
973 @cindex user config file
974 @cindex config file, overview
975
976 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
977 in one place.
978 One of the following will match your situation best:
979
980 @itemize
981 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
982 provided by someone else.
983 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
984 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
985 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
986 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
987 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
988 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
989
990 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
991 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
992
993 @enumerate
994 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
995 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
996 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
997 @end enumerate
998
999 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
1000 The first is an interface config file.
1001 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
1002 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
1003 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
1004 meet your deadline:
1005
1006 @example
1007 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
1008 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
1009 @end example
1010
1011 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
1012 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
1013 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1014 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1015
1016 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1017 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1018 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1019 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1020 target and board
1021 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1022 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1023
1024 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1025 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1026 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1027 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1028
1029 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1030 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1031 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1032 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1033 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1034
1035 @quotation Note
1036 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1037 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1038 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1039 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1040 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1041 @end quotation
1042
1043 @item
1044 You may need to write some C code.
1045 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1046 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1047 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1048 a new chip architecture.
1049 @end itemize
1050
1051 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1052 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1053 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1054
1055 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1056 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1057 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1058 @itemize
1059
1060 @item
1061 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1062 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1063 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1064 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1065
1066 @item
1067 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1068 @cindex vector_catch
1069 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1070 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1071 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1072 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1073 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1074 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1075
1076 @item
1077 You might need to override some defaults.
1078 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1079 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1080
1081 @item
1082 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1083 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1084 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1085 @end itemize
1086
1087 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1088
1089 A few project-specific utility
1090 routines may well speed up your work.
1091 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1092
1093 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1094 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1095 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1096 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1097 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1098 may help:
1099
1100 @example
1101 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1102 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1103 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1104 # Leave the CPU halted.
1105 reset init
1106
1107 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1108 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1109
1110 # Start running.
1111 resume 0x20000000
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1116 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1117 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1118 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1119 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1120
1121 @example
1122 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1123 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1124 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1125 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1126 reset init
1127
1128 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1129 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1130 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1131 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1132 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1133 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1134 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1135
1136 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1137 reset run
1138 @}
1139 @end example
1140
1141 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1142 from NAND.
1143 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1144 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1145 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1146
1147 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1148 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1149
1150 @section Target Software Changes
1151
1152 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1153 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1154 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1155 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1156 handling issues like:
1157
1158 @itemize @bullet
1159
1160 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1161 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1162 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1163 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1164 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1165 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1166 your debug sessions.
1167
1168 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1169 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1170 That might however be your only option.
1171
1172 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1173 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1174 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1175 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1176 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1177 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1178 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1179 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1180 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1181 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1182 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1183 instead of the whole thing.
1184 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1185 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1186
1187 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1188 @cindex ARM semihosting
1189 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1190 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1191 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1192 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1193 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1194 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1195 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1196 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1197 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1198 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1199 NAND or SPI flash.
1200
1201 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1202 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1203 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1204 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1205 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1206
1207 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1208 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1209 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1210 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1211 registers which can be used to change various features including
1212 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1213 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1214 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1215 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1216 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1217
1218 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1219 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1220 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1221 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1222 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1223
1224 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1225 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1226 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1227 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1228 early code execution can be debugged
1229 or firmware can be replaced.
1230
1231 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1232 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1233 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1234 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1235 operations like writing to memory.)
1236
1237 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1238 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1239 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1240 various kinds of message.
1241 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1242
1243 @end itemize
1244
1245 @section Target Hardware Setup
1246
1247 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1248 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1249 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1250 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1251 working with.}
1252
1253 Common issues include:
1254
1255 @itemize @bullet
1256
1257 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1258 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1259 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1260 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1261 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1262 or one from a daughtercard).
1263 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1264 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1265
1266 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1267 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1268 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1269 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1270 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1271 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1272
1273 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1274 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1275 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1276 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1277 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1278
1279
1280 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1281 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1282 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1283 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1284 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1285 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1286 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1287
1288 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1289 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1290 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1291 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1292 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1293
1294 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1295 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1296 used to start booting.
1297
1298 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1299 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1300 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1301 multiple audio codec chips).
1302 This interacts with software
1303 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1304 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1305 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1306 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1307 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1308 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1309 audio or video codecs are used.
1310
1311 @end itemize
1312
1313 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1314 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1315 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1316 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1317 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1318 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1319 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1320 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1321 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1322 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1323
1324
1325 @node Config File Guidelines
1326 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1327
1328 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1329 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1330 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1331 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1332
1333 You should find the following directories under
1334 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1335 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1336 @itemize @bullet
1337 @item @file{interface} ...
1338 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1339 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1340 @item @file{board} ...
1341 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1342 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1343
1344 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1345 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1346 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1347 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1348 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1349 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1350 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1351 a CPU and an FPGA.
1352 @item @file{target} ...
1353 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1354 on a chip
1355 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1356 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1357 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1358 the target config file defines all of them.
1359 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1360 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1361 @end itemize
1362
1363 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1364 file may override features in any of the above files by
1365 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1366 commands specific to their situation.
1367
1368 @section Interface Config Files
1369
1370 The user config file
1371 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1372
1373 @example
1374 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1375 @end example
1376
1377 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1378 in use today with OpenOCD.
1379 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1380 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1381
1382 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1383 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1384 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1385 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1386 and need to provide a driver for it.
1387
1388 @section Board Config Files
1389 @cindex config file, board
1390 @cindex board config file
1391
1392 The user config file
1393 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1394
1395 @example
1396 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1397 @end example
1398
1399 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1400 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1401 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1402
1403 @enumerate
1404 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1405 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1406 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1407 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1408 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1409 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1410 @end enumerate
1411
1412 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1413 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1414 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1415 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1416
1417 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1418 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1419 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1420 configuration works.
1421
1422 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1423
1424 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1425 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1426 convention on how to use certain variables.
1427
1428 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1429 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1430 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1431 used at will within a target configuration file.
1432
1433 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1434 for a board with three chips:
1435
1436 @example
1437 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1438 set CHIPNAME network
1439 set ENDIAN big
1440 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1441 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1442 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1443 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1444
1445 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1446 set CHIPNAME video
1447 set ENDIAN little
1448 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1449 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1450 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1451 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1452
1453 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1454 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1455 unset ENDIAN
1456 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1457 @end example
1458
1459 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1460 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1461 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1462 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1463 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1464 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1465 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1466 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1467
1468 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1469 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1470 naming collisions.
1471
1472 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1473 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1474 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1475 up other clocks and peripherals.
1476
1477 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1478 @cindex variable names
1479
1480 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1481 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1482 one such chip (as shown above).
1483 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1484 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1485 to promote consistency and
1486 so that board files can override target defaults.
1487
1488 Inputs to target config files include:
1489
1490 @itemize @bullet
1491 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1492 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1493 tap identifier dotted names.
1494 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1495 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1496 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1497 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1498 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1499 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1500 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1501 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1502 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1503 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1504 @end itemize
1505
1506 Outputs from target config files include:
1507
1508 @itemize @bullet
1509 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1510 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1511 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1512 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1513 specific to that board and that target.
1514 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1515 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1516 @end itemize
1517
1518 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1519 @cindex event, reset-init
1520 @cindex reset-init handler
1521
1522 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1523 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1524 fully set up yet.
1525 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1526 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1527 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1528 handler is one of the most important.
1529
1530 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1531 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1532 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1533 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1534 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1535
1536 @quotation Note
1537 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1538 are included here.
1539 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1540 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1541 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1542 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1543 @end quotation
1544
1545 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1546 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1547 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1548 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1549 those as parameters.
1550 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1551 and disabling the watchdog.
1552 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1553 the next developer doing such work.
1554 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1555
1556 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1557 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1558 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1559 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1560
1561 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1562
1563 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1564 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1565 a low JTAG clock rate.
1566 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1567 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1568 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1569 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1570 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1571 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1572 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1573
1574 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1575 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1576 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1577 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1578 which might be less than that.
1579
1580 @quotation Warning
1581 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1582 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1583 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1584 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1585 @end quotation
1586
1587 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1588 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1589 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1590 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1591 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1592 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1593
1594 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1595 @subsection The init_board procedure
1596 @cindex init_board procedure
1597
1598 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1599 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1600 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1601 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1602 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1603 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1604 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1605 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1606 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1607 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1608 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1609 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1610
1611 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1612 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1613
1614 @example
1615 ### board_file.cfg ###
1616
1617 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1618 source [find target/target.cfg]
1619
1620 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1621 # enables fast on-board clock source
1622 # configures the chip to use it
1623 @}
1624
1625 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1626 proc init_board @{@} @{
1627 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1628
1629 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1630 adapter speed 100
1631 @}
1632
1633 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1634 enable_fast_clock
1635 adapter speed 10000
1636 @}
1637 @}
1638 @end example
1639
1640 @section Target Config Files
1641 @cindex config file, target
1642 @cindex target config file
1643
1644 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1645 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1646 more target config files like this:
1647
1648 @example
1649 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1650 @end example
1651
1652 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1653 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1654 In summary the target files should contain
1655
1656 @enumerate
1657 @item Set defaults
1658 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1659 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1660 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1661 @item On-Chip flash
1662 @end enumerate
1663
1664 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1665 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1666 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1667
1668 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1669 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1670 can talk to the chip.
1671 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1672 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1673 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1674 and other processing engines.
1675
1676 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1677
1678 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1679 letting board config files express environment-specific
1680 differences in how things should be set up.
1681
1682 @example
1683 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1684 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1685 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1686 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1689 @}
1690
1691 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1692 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1693 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1694 @} else @{
1695 set _ENDIAN little
1696 @}
1697
1698 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1699 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1700 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1701 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1702 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1703 @} else @{
1704 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1705 @}
1706 @end example
1707 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1708
1709 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1710 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1711 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1712
1713 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1714 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1715 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1716
1717 @example
1718 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1719 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1720 @end example
1721
1722 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1723 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1724 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1725 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1726 for taps.
1727
1728 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1729 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1730 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1731 looks (in part) like this:
1732
1733 @example
1734 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1735 @end example
1736
1737 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1738 to source such a config file twice, with different
1739 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1740 it adds a different TAP each time.
1741
1742 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1743 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1744 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1745 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1746
1747 @example
1748 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1749 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1750 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1751 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1752 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1753 @end example
1754
1755 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1756 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1757
1758 @itemize
1759 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1760 plus a JRC to enable them
1761 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1762 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1763 is not currently used)
1764 @end itemize
1765
1766 @subsection Add CPU targets
1767
1768 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1769 GDB and other commands can use it.
1770 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1771 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1772 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1773 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1774
1775 @example
1776 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1777 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1778 @end example
1779
1780 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1781 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1782 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1783 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1784 a work area if you can.
1785 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1786
1787 @example
1788 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1789 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1790 @end example
1791
1792 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1793 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1794 @cindex SMP
1795 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1796
1797 @example
1798 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1799 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1800 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1801 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1802 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1803 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1804 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1805 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1806 @end example
1807 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1808 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1809 @itemize @bullet
1810 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1811 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1812 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1813 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1814 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1815 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1816 @end itemize
1817
1818 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1819 command have been implemented.
1820 @itemize @bullet
1821 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1822 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1823 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1824 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1825 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1826 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1827 following example.
1828 @end itemize
1829
1830 @example
1831 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1832 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1833 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1834 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1835 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1836 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1837 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1838 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1839 > resume
1840 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1841 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1842 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1843 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1844 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1845 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1846 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1847 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1848 @end example
1849
1850
1851 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1852
1853 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1854 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1855 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1856
1857 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1858 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1859 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1860 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1861 both signals.
1862
1863 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1864 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1865 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1866 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1867 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1868 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1869 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1870 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1871 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1872 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1873 not available.)
1874
1875 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1876 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1877 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1878 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1879 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1880 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1881 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1882 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1883
1884 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1885 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1886 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1887 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1888 slower clock than they will use later.
1889 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1890 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1891 than they will use later.
1892 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1893
1894 @quotation Important
1895 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1896 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1897 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1898 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1899 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1900 @end quotation
1901
1902 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1903 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1904 @cindex init_targets procedure
1905
1906 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1907 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1908 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1909 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1910 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1911 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1912 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1913 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1914 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1915
1916 @example
1917 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1918
1919 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1920 # basic initialization procedure ...
1921 @}
1922
1923 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1924 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1925 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1926 @}
1927
1928 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1929
1930 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1931
1932 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1933 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1934 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1935 @}
1936 @end example
1937
1938 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1939 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1940
1941 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1942
1943 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1944 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1945
1946 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1947 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1948 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1949
1950 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1951 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1952 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1953 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1954 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1955 events already assigned.
1956
1957 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1958
1959 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1960 special high speed download features - enable it.
1961
1962 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1963
1964 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1965 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1966 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1967 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1968 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1969 If you are using an external trace port,
1970 configure it in your board config file.
1971 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1972 configure it in your target config file.
1973
1974 @example
1975 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1976 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1977 @end example
1978
1979 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1980
1981 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1982
1983 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1984 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1985 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1986 the TARGET (chip) file.
1987
1988 Examples:
1989 @itemize @bullet
1990 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1991 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1992 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1993 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1994 @end itemize
1995
1996 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1997 @section Translating Configuration Files
1998 @cindex translation
1999 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
2000 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
2001 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
2002 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
2003 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
2004 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
2005
2006 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2007 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2008 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2009 convert other scripts later on.
2010
2011 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2012 replace job:
2013
2014 @example
2015 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2016 #
2017 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2018 #
2019 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2020 #
2021 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2022
2023 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2024 global TARGETNAME
2025
2026 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2027
2028 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2029 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2030 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2031 @}
2032 @end example
2033
2034
2035
2036 @node Server Configuration
2037 @chapter Server Configuration
2038 @cindex initialization
2039 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2040 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2041 supported.
2042
2043 @anchor{configurationstage}
2044 @section Configuration Stage
2045 @cindex configuration stage
2046 @cindex config command
2047
2048 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2049 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2050 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2051 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2052 inside startup scripts.
2053
2054 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2055 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2056 which may be issued interactively.
2057 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2058 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2059
2060 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2061 flash banks,
2062 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2063 and other basic setup.
2064 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2065 may access or activate TAPs.
2066 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2067 longer be issued.
2068
2069 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2070 @section Entering the Run Stage
2071
2072 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2073 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2074 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2076 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2077 You should see no errors at this point.
2078 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2079 commands you used to configure the server.
2080 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2081 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2082 on the scan chain.
2083
2084 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2085 become available.
2086 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2087 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2088 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2089 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2090 entry to the run stage.
2091
2092 @deffn {Config Command} init
2093 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2094 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2095 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2096 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2097 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2098 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2099
2100 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2101 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2102 configuration files and/or command line options.
2103
2104 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2105 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2106 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2107 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2108 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2109 @end deffn
2110
2111 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2112 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2113 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2114
2115 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2116 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2117 scan chain.
2118 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2119 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2120
2121 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2122 they return.
2123 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2124 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2125 @end deffn
2126
2127 @anchor{tcpipports}
2128 @section TCP/IP Ports
2129 @cindex TCP port
2130 @cindex server
2131 @cindex port
2132 @cindex security
2133 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2134 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2135 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2136
2137 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2138 access using one or more of these ports.
2139 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2140 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2141 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2142
2143 @anchor{gdb_port}
2144 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2145 @cindex GDB server
2146 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2147 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2148 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2149 the normal use cases.
2150
2151 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2152 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2153 disables the gdb server.
2154
2155 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2156 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2157
2158 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2159 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2160
2161 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2162 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2163 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2164
2165 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2166 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2167 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2168 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2169 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2170 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2171 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2172 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2173 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2174
2175 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2176 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2177 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2178 @end deffn
2179
2180 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2181 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2182 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2183 output from the Tcl engine.
2184 Intended as a machine interface.
2185 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2186 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2187 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2188 @end deffn
2189
2190 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2191 Specify or query the
2192 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2193 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2194 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2195 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2196 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2197 @end deffn
2198
2199 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2200 @section GDB Configuration
2201 @cindex GDB
2202 @cindex GDB configuration
2203 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2204 The ones listed here are static and global.
2205 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2206 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2207
2208 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2209 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2210 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2211 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2212 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2213 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2214 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2215 @end deffn
2216
2217 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2218 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2220 vFlash packet is received.
2221 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2222 @end deffn
2223
2224 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2225 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2226 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2227 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2228 for flash programming to work.
2229 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2230 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2231 @end deffn
2232
2233 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2234 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2235 by GDB memory read packets.
2236 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2237 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2238 @end deffn
2239
2240 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2241 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2242 packets report errors or not.
2243 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2244 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2245 @end deffn
2246
2247 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2248 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2249 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2250 @end deffn
2251
2252 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2253 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2254
2255 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2256 @end deffn
2257
2258 @anchor{eventpolling}
2259 @section Event Polling
2260
2261 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2262 where significant events can happen at any time.
2263 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2264 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2265 or to GDB.
2266
2267 Examples of such events include:
2268
2269 @itemize
2270 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2271 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2272 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2273 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2274 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2275 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2276 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2277 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2278 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2279 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2280 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2281 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2282 @end itemize
2283
2284 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2285 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2286 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2287 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2288 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2289
2290 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2291 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2292 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2293 to the various active targets.
2294 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2295 which is normally done in the background.
2296
2297 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2298 Poll the current target for its current state.
2299 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2300 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2301 specific information about the current state is printed.
2302 An optional parameter
2303 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2304
2305 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2306 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2307 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2308 @example
2309 > poll
2310 background polling: on
2311 target state: halted
2312 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2313 current mode: Supervisor
2314 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2315 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2316 >
2317 @end example
2318 @end deffn
2319
2320 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2321 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2322 @cindex config file, interface
2323 @cindex interface config file
2324
2325 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2326 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2327 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2328
2329 @quotation Note
2330 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2331 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2332 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2333 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2334 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2335 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2336 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2337 @end quotation
2338
2339 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2340 through commands in an interface configuration
2341 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2342 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2343
2344 @example
2345 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2346 @end example
2347
2348 These commands tell
2349 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2350 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2351
2352 @example
2353 # jlink interface
2354 adapter driver jlink
2355 @end example
2356
2357 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2358
2359
2360 @section Adapter Configuration
2361
2362 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2363 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2364 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2365
2366 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2367 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2368 target.
2369 @end deffn
2370
2371 @deffn Command {adapter list}
2372 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2373 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2374 @end deffn
2375 @deffn Command {adapter transports} transport_name+
2376 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2377 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2378 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2379 the hardware can support.
2380 @end deffn
2381
2382
2383
2384 @deffn Command {adapter name}
2385 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2389 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2390 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2391 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2392 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2393 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2394 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2395
2396 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2397 @end deffn
2398
2399 @section Interface Drivers
2400
2401 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2402 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2403 available at run time.
2404
2405 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2406 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2407 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2408 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2409
2410 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2411 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2412 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2413 @end deffn
2414
2415 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2416 Displays status of RTCK option.
2417 Optionally sets that option first.
2418 @end deffn
2419 @end deffn
2420
2421 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2422 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2423 This has one driver-specific command:
2424
2425 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2426 Logs some status
2427 @end deffn
2428 @end deffn
2429
2430 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2431 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2432 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2433 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2434 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2435 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2436 @end deffn
2437
2438 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2439 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2440 or v2 (USB bulk).
2441
2442 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2443 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2444 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2445 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2446 @example
2447 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2448 @end example
2449 @end deffn
2450
2451 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2452 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2453 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2454 @end deffn
2455
2456 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2457 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2458
2459 @itemize @minus
2460 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2461 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2462 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2463 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2464 @end itemize
2465 @end deffn
2466
2467 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2468 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2469 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2470 interface string or for user class interface.
2471 @end deffn
2472
2473 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2474 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2475 @end deffn
2476 @end deffn
2477
2478 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2479 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2480 @end deffn
2481
2482 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2483 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2484 @end deffn
2485
2486 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2487 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2488 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2489
2490 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2491 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2492
2493 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2494 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2495
2496 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2497 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2498 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2499 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2500 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2501 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2502
2503 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2504 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2505 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2506 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2507 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2508
2509 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2510 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2511 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2512 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2513
2514 @itemize @minus
2515 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2516 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2517 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2518 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2519 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2520 switching data and direction as necessary
2521 @end itemize
2522
2523 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2524 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2525
2526 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2527 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2528 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2529 @example
2530 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2531 @end example
2532 @end deffn
2533
2534 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2535 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2536 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2537 during device selection.
2538 @end deffn
2539
2540 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2541 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2542 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2543 is connected to the host.
2544 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2545 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2546 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2547 @end deffn
2548
2549 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2550 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2551 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2552
2553 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2554 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2555 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2556 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2557 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2558
2559 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2560 @end deffn
2561
2562 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2563 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2564 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2565 @end deffn
2566
2567 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2568 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2569 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2570 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2571 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2572 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2573 and initially asserted reset signals.
2574 @end deffn
2575
2576 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2577 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2578 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2579 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2580 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2581 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2582 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2583 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2584 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2585 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2586 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2587
2588 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2589 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2590 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2591 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2592 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2593 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2594
2595 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2596 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2597 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2598 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2599 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2600 are always driven by the FTDI.
2601
2602 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2603 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2604 @var{name}.
2605 @end deffn
2606
2607 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2608 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2609 @itemize @minus
2610 @item @option{0}, drive low
2611 @item @option{1}, drive high
2612 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2613 @end itemize
2614 @end deffn
2615
2616 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2617 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2618 @end deffn
2619
2620 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2621 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2622
2623 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2624 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2625 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2626 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2627 @itemize @minus
2628 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2629 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2630 @end itemize
2631 @end deffn
2632
2633 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2634 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2635
2636 @end deffn
2637
2638 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2639 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2640 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2641 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2642
2643 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2644 @itemize @minus
2645 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2646 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2647 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2648 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2649 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2650 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2651 @end itemize
2652
2653 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2654 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2655 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2656 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2657 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2658 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2659 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2660 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2661
2662 FT232R
2663 @itemize @minus
2664 @item bit 7 - RI
2665 @item bit 6 - DCD
2666 @item bit 5 - DSR
2667 @item bit 4 - DTR
2668 @item bit 3 - CTS
2669 @item bit 2 - RTS
2670 @item bit 1 - RXD
2671 @item bit 0 - TXD
2672 @end itemize
2673
2674 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2675 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2676
2677 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2678 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2679 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2680 @end deffn
2681
2682 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2683 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2684 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2685 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2689 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2690 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2691 @end deffn
2692
2693 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2694 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2695 @end deffn
2696
2697 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2698 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2699 @end deffn
2700
2701 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2702 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2703 @end deffn
2704
2705 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2706 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2707 @end deffn
2708
2709 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2710 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2711 @end deffn
2712
2713 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2714 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2715 @end deffn
2716
2717 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2718 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2719 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2720 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2721 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2722 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2723 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2724 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2725 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2726 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2727 @end deffn
2728
2729 @end deffn
2730
2731 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2732 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2733 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2734 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2735
2736 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2737 processors which are being simulated.
2738
2739 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2740 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2741 sockets instead of TCP.
2742 @end deffn
2743
2744 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2745 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2746 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2747 @end deffn
2748
2749 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2750 something like:
2751
2752 @example
2753 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2754 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2755 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2756 @end example
2757
2758 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2759 named mysocket:
2760
2761 @example
2762 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2763 remote_bitbang_port 0
2764 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2765 @end example
2766 @end deffn
2767
2768 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2769 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2770 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2771 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2772
2773 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2774 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2775 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2776 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2777 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2778 @end deffn
2779
2780 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2781 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2782 default values are used.
2783 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2784 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2785 @example
2786 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2787 @end example
2788 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2789 @example
2790 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2791 @end example
2792 @end deffn
2793
2794 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2795 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2796 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2797 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2798 target board.
2799
2800 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2801 @example
2802 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2803 reset_config srst_only
2804 @end example
2805 @end deffn
2806
2807 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2808 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2809 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2810 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2811 @end deffn
2812
2813 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2814 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2815 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2816 @end deffn
2817
2818 @end deffn
2819
2820 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2821 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2822 This has one driver-specific command:
2823
2824 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2825 Display either the address of the I/O port
2826 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2827 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2828 This is a write-once setting.
2829 @end deffn
2830 @end deffn
2831
2832 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2833 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2834 transports.
2835
2836 @quotation Compatibility Note
2837 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2838 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2839 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2840 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2841 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2842 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2843 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2844 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2845 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2846 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2847 @end quotation
2848
2849 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2850 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2851 states.
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2854 Display free device internal memory.
2855 @end deffn
2856 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2857 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2858 command version.
2859 @end deffn
2860 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2861 Display the device configuration.
2862 @end deffn
2863 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2864 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2865 power state.
2866 @end deffn
2867 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2868 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2869 @end deffn
2870 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2871 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2872 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2873 IP configuration.
2874 @end deffn
2875 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2876 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2877 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2878 @end deffn
2879 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2880 Reset the current configuration.
2881 @end deffn
2882 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2883 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2884 @end deffn
2885 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2886 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2887 pairs.
2888
2889 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2890 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2891 @example
2892 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2893 @end example
2894 @end deffn
2895 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2896 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2897 pairs.
2898
2899 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2900 @example
2901 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2902 77a90000
2903 @end example
2904 @end deffn
2905 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2906 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2907 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2908 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2909 the serial number instead, if possible.
2910
2911 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2912 @end deffn
2913 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2914 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2915 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2916
2917 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2918 @end deffn
2919 @end deffn
2920
2921 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2922 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2923 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2924 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2925 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2926 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2927 configuration script.
2928
2929 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2930 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2931 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2932 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2933 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2934
2935 Known limitations:
2936 @itemize @bullet
2937 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2938 and 2.7 MHz.
2939 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2940 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2941 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2942 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2943 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2944 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2945 communications with the target.
2946 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2947 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2948 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2949 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2950 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2951 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2952 @end itemize
2953
2954 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2955 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2956 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2957 @end deffn
2958
2959 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2960 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2961 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2962 @end deffn
2963
2964 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2965 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2966 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2967 target as a side-effect.
2968 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2969 @end deffn
2970
2971 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2972 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2973 version, and target voltage.
2974 @end deffn
2975 @end deffn
2976
2977 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2978 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2979 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2980 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2981 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2982
2983 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2984 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2985 This is a write-once setting.
2986 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2987
2988 @itemize @minus
2989 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2990 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2991 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2992 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2993 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2994 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2995 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2996 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2997 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2998 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2999 some versions of
3000 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
3001 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
3002 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
3003 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
3004 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
3005 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
3006 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
3007 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
3008 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
3009 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
3010 @end itemize
3011 @end deffn
3012
3013 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
3014 Display either the address of the I/O port
3015 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
3016 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
3017 This is a write-once setting.
3018
3019 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3020 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
3021 you may encounter a problem.
3022 @end deffn
3023
3024 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3025 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3026 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3027 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3028 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3029 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3030
3031 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3032 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3033 @quotation Tip
3034 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3035 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3036 @example
3037 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3038 > adapter speed 500
3039 @end example
3040 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3041 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3042 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3043 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3044 large set of samples.
3045 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3046 @example
3047 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3048 @end example
3049 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3050 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3051
3052 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3053 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3054 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3055 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3056 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3057 be conservative.
3058 @end quotation
3059 @end deffn
3060
3061 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3062 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3063 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3064 @end deffn
3065
3066 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3067 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3068
3069 @example
3070 adapter driver parport
3071 parport_port 0x278
3072 parport_cable wiggler
3073 @end example
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3077 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3078 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3079 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3080 @end deffn
3081 @end deffn
3082
3083 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3084 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3085 @end deffn
3086
3087 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3088 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3089 @end deffn
3090
3091 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3092 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3093
3094 @quotation Note
3095 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3096 which are not currently documented here.
3097 @end quotation
3098 @end deffn
3099
3100 @anchor{hla_interface}
3101 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3102 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3103 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3104 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3105
3106 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3107 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3108 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3109 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3110 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3111 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3112
3113 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3114 Currently Not Supported.
3115 @end deffn
3116
3117 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3118 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3119 @end deffn
3120
3121 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3122 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3123 @end deffn
3124
3125 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3126 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3127 @end deffn
3128
3129 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3130 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3131 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3132 @end deffn
3133 @end deffn
3134
3135 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3136 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3137 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3138 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3139 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3140
3141 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3142 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3143 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3144 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3145
3146 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3147 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3148
3149 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3150 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3151 @end deffn
3152
3153 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3154 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3155 @end deffn
3156 @end deffn
3157
3158 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3159 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3160 @end deffn
3161
3162 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3163 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3164 @end deffn
3165
3166 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3167 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3168 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3169 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3170 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3171
3172 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3173 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3174 XDS110 found will be used.
3175 @end deffn
3176
3177 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3178 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3179 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3180 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3181 @end deffn
3182
3183 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3184 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3185 version).
3186 @end deffn
3187 @end deffn
3188
3189 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3190 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3191 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3192 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3193 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3194
3195 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3196
3197 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3198 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3199
3200 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3201 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3202
3203 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3204
3205 @end deffn
3206 @end deffn
3207
3208 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3209 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3210 @end deffn
3211
3212 @quotation Note
3213 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3214 which are not currently documented here.
3215 @end quotation
3216
3217 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3218 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3219 No arguments: print status.
3220 @end deffn
3221
3222 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3223 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3224 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3225
3226 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3227 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3228 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3229 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3230 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3231 configuration on exit.
3232
3233 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3234 pinout.
3235
3236 @end deffn
3237
3238 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3239 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3240 of the one which is most popular.
3241
3242 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3243
3244 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3245 pinout.
3246
3247 @end deffn
3248
3249
3250 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3251 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3252 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3253
3254 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3255 @end deffn
3256
3257
3258 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3259 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3260 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3261
3262 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3263 @end deffn
3264
3265
3266 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3267 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3268 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3269
3270 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3271 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3272 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3273
3274 @itemize @minus
3275 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3276 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3277 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3278 @end itemize
3279 @end deffn
3280
3281 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3282 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3283 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3284 @end deffn
3285 @end deffn
3286
3287
3288 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3289 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3290 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3291 DPI server interface.
3292
3293 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_port} port
3294 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3295 @end deffn
3296
3297 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_address} address
3298 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3299 @end deffn
3300 @end deffn
3301
3302
3303 @section Transport Configuration
3304 @cindex Transport
3305 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3306 and the debug adapter you are using,
3307 several transports may be available to
3308 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3309 @deffn Command {transport list}
3310 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3311 version of OpenOCD.
3312 @end deffn
3313
3314 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3315 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3316
3317 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3318 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3319 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3320 adapter's driver).
3321
3322 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3323 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3324 supported by the debug adapter.
3325
3326 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3327 transport, if any.
3328 @end deffn
3329
3330 @subsection JTAG Transport
3331 @cindex JTAG
3332 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3333 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3334 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3335 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3336 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3337 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3338
3339 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3340 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3341 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3342 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3343 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3344
3345 @subsection SWD Transport
3346 @cindex SWD
3347 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3348 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3349 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3350 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3351 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3352 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3353 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3354
3355 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3356 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3357 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3358 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3359 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3360
3361 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3362 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3363 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3364 expected to change.
3365 @end deffn
3366 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3367 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3368 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3369 No parameters: displays current settings.
3370 @end deffn
3371
3372 @subsection SPI Transport
3373 @cindex SPI
3374 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3375 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3376 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3377 solution for flash programming.
3378
3379 @anchor{swimtransport}
3380 @subsection SWIM Transport
3381 @cindex SWIM
3382 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3383 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3384 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3385 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3386
3387 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3388
3389 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3390
3391 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3392 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3393 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3394 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3395 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3396
3397 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3398 @section JTAG Speed
3399 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3400 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3401 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3402 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3403 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3404 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3405 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3406 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3407 power management software that may be active.
3408
3409 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3410 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3411 target event handler.
3412 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3413 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3414 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3415 sets up those clocks).
3416 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3417 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3418 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3419 in the target config file.
3420 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3421 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3422 config file instead.
3423 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3424 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3425 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3426
3427 @example
3428 jtag_rclk 3000
3429 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3430 @end example
3431
3432 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3433 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3434 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3435 may not be the fastest solution.
3436
3437 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3438 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3439 which support adaptive clocking.
3440
3441 @deffn {Command} adapter speed max_speed_kHz
3442 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3443 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3444 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3445 than the speed specified.
3446
3447 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3448 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3449 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3450 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3451
3452 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3453 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3454 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3455 JTAG clocking after setup.
3456 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3457 If the interface device can not
3458 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3459 @end deffn
3460
3461 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3462 @cindex adaptive clocking
3463 @cindex RTCK
3464 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3465 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3466 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3467 @example
3468 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3469 jtag_rclk 3000
3470 @end example
3471 @end defun
3472
3473 @node Reset Configuration
3474 @chapter Reset Configuration
3475 @cindex Reset Configuration
3476
3477 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3478 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3479 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3480 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3481 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3482 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3483 Please see the various board files for examples.
3484
3485 @quotation Note
3486 To maintainers and integrators:
3487 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3488 Normally the board configuration file
3489 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3490 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3491
3492 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3493 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3494 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3495 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3496 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3497 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3498 @end quotation
3499
3500 @section Types of Reset
3501
3502 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3503 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3504 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3505
3506 @itemize @bullet
3507 @item
3508 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3509 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3510 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3511 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3512 @item
3513 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3514 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3515 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3516 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3517 @item
3518 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3519 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3520 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3521 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3522 @item
3523 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3524 several other types of reset.
3525 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3526 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3527 There may be individual module resets.
3528 @end itemize
3529
3530 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3531 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3532 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3533 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3534 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3535 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3536 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3537 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3538 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3539
3540 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3541 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3542
3543 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3544 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3545 common issues are:
3546
3547 @itemize @bullet
3548
3549 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3550 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3551 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3552 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3553 when either of those signals is not connected.
3554 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3555 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3556 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3557 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3558
3559 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3560 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3561 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3562 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3563
3564 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3565 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3566 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3567 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3568 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3569 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3570 hardware debouncing.
3571 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3572 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3573
3574 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3575 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3576 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3577 to use push/pull output drivers.
3578 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3579 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3580 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3581 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3582
3583 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3584 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3585 issues (not limited to errata).
3586 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3587 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3588 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3589 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3590 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3591 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3592 @end itemize
3593
3594 There can also be other issues.
3595 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3596 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3597 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3598 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3599 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3600 Agreement (NDA).
3601
3602 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3603 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3604 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3605
3606 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3607 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3608
3609 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3610
3611 @deffn {Command} adapter srst pulse_width milliseconds
3612 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3613 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3614 allowing it to be deasserted.
3615 @end deffn
3616
3617 @deffn {Command} adapter srst delay milliseconds
3618 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3619 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3620 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3621 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3622 @end deffn
3623
3624 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3625 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3626 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3627 allowing it to be deasserted.
3628 @end deffn
3629
3630 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3631 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3632 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3633 @end deffn
3634
3635 @anchor{reset_config}
3636 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3637 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3638 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3639 configuration scripts.
3640
3641 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3642 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3643 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3644 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3645 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3646 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3647 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3648 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3649
3650 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3651 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3652 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3653 -- may be specified at a time.
3654 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3655 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3656 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3657 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3658 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3659
3660 @itemize
3661 @item
3662 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3663 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3664 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3665 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3666 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3667
3668 @quotation Tip
3669 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3670 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3671 @end quotation
3672
3673 @item
3674 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3675 signal implementations.
3676 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3677 indicating everything behaves normally.
3678 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3679 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3680 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3681 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3682 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3683 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3684 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3685
3686 @item
3687 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3688 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3689 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3690 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3691 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3692 while SRST is asserted.
3693 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3694 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3695
3696 @item
3697 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3698 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3699 is required to use this option.
3700 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3701 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3702 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3703 be asserted before any target connection.
3704 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3705 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3706 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3707 @end itemize
3708
3709 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3710 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3711 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3712 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3713 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3714
3715 @itemize
3716 @item
3717 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3718 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3719 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3720 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3721
3722 @item
3723 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3724 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3725 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3726 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3727 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3728 @end itemize
3729 @end deffn
3730
3731 @section Custom Reset Handling
3732 @cindex events
3733
3734 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3735 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3736 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3737 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3738 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3739 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3740
3741 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3742 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3743 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3744 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3745 want to reset everything at once.
3746
3747 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3748 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3749 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3750 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3751 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3752 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3753 needs special attention.
3754
3755 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3756 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3757 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3758 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3759 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3760 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3761 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3762 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3763 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3764
3765 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3766 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3767 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3768 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3769 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3770
3771 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3772 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3773 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3774 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3775 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3776 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3777 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3778 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3779 or potentially some other value.
3780
3781 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3782 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3783 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3784 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3785 (or their associated targets)
3786 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3787
3788 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3789 they return.
3790 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3791 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3792 @end deffn
3793
3794 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3795 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3796 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3797 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3798 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3799 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3800 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3801 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3802 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3803 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3804 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3805 @end deffn
3806
3807 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3808 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3809 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3810 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3811 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3812 @end deffn
3813
3814
3815 @node TAP Declaration
3816 @chapter TAP Declaration
3817 @cindex TAP declaration
3818 @cindex TAP configuration
3819
3820 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3821 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3822
3823 @itemize @bullet
3824 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3825 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3826 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3827 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3828 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3829 start running that code.
3830 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3831 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3832 and missing connections.
3833 @end itemize
3834
3835 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3836 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3837 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3838 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3839 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3840
3841 @section Scan Chains
3842 @cindex scan chain
3843
3844 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3845 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3846 They also need to be added to
3847 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3848 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3849 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3850 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3851 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3852 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3853 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3854 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3855
3856 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3857 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3858 command, presented in the next chapter.
3859 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3860 debugging targets.)
3861 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3862
3863 @verbatim
3864 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3865 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3866 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3867 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3868 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3869 @end verbatim
3870
3871 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3872 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3873 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3874 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3875 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3876 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3877 until they are told to do so.
3878
3879 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3880 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3881 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3882 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3883
3884 @example
3885 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3886 @end example
3887
3888 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3889 by a given chip.
3890 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3891 and so forth.
3892 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3893 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3894 both inside a single chip and between them.
3895 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3896
3897 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3898 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3899 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3900 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3901 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3902 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3903 includes commands something like this:
3904
3905 @example
3906 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3907 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3908 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3909 @end example
3910
3911 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3912 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3913 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3914
3915 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3916 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3917 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3918 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3919 @example
3920 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3921 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3922 @}
3923 @end example
3924 @end deffn
3925
3926 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3927 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3928 and their status.
3929 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3930 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3931 but systems with a JTAG router can
3932 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3933 @end deffn
3934
3935 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3936 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3937
3938 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3939 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3940
3941 @section TAP Names
3942 @cindex dotted name
3943
3944 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3945 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3946 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3947 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3948 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3949 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3950 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3951 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3952
3953 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3954 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3955 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3956
3957 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3958
3959 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3960 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3961 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3962 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3963
3964 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3965 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3966 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3967 overridable.
3968
3969 @cindex TAP naming convention
3970 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3971 and should follow this convention:
3972
3973 @itemize @bullet
3974 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3975 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3976 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3977 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3978 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3979 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3980 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3981 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3982 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3983 with a single TAP;
3984 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3985 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3986 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3987 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3988 @end itemize
3989
3990 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3991
3992 @itemize @bullet
3993 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3994 @*The length in bits of the
3995 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3996 @end itemize
3997
3998 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3999
4000 @itemize @bullet
4001 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4002 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4003 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4004 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4005 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4006 (the TAP is linked in).
4007 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4008 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4009 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4010 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4011 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4012 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4013 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4014 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4015 values that were found but not included in the list.
4016
4017 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4018 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4019 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4020 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4021 hardware to find these values.
4022 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4023 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4024 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4025 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4026 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4027 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4028 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4029 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4030 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4031 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4032 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4033 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4034 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4035 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4036 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4037 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4038 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4039 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4040 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4041 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4042 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4043 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4044 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4045 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4046 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4047 @end itemize
4048 @end deffn
4049
4050 @section Other TAP commands
4051
4052 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4053 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4054 @end deffn
4055
4056 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4057 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4058 At this writing this TAP attribute
4059 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4060 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4061 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4062 See the next section for information about the available events.
4063
4064 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4065 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4066 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4067 @end deffn
4068
4069 @section TAP Events
4070 @cindex events
4071 @cindex TAP events
4072
4073 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4074 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4075 The other applies to debugger targets,
4076 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4077
4078 The TAP events currently defined are:
4079
4080 @itemize @bullet
4081 @item @b{post-reset}
4082 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4083 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4084 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4085 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4086 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4087
4088 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4089 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4090 of any particular target.
4091 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4092 @item @b{setup}
4093 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4094 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4095 @item @b{tap-disable}
4096 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4097 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4098 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4099 @item @b{tap-enable}
4100 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4101 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4102 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4103 @end itemize
4104
4105 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4106 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4107 contents to be accurate), you might:
4108
4109 @example
4110 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4111 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4112 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4113 @}
4114 @end example
4115
4116
4117 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4118 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4119 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4120 @cindex jrc
4121
4122 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4123 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4124 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4125 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4126 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4127
4128 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4129 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4130 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4131 be visible.
4132 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4133 ignores, such as:
4134
4135 @itemize
4136 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4137 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4138 TAPs receive new instructions.
4139 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4140 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4141 @end itemize
4142
4143 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4144 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4145 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4146 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4147
4148 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4149 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4150
4151 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4152 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4153 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4154 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4155 should define TAP event handlers using
4156 code that looks something like this:
4157
4158 @example
4159 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4160 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4161 @}
4162 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4163 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4164 @}
4165 @end example
4166
4167 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4168
4169 @example
4170 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4171 @end example
4172
4173 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4174 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4175 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4176 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4177
4178 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4179 If necessary, disables the tap
4180 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4181 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4182 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4183 and "0" if it is disabled.
4184 @end deffn
4185
4186 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4187 If necessary, enables the tap
4188 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4189 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4190 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4191 and "0" if it is disabled.
4192 @end deffn
4193
4194 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4195 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4196 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4197 and "0" if it is disabled.
4198
4199 @quotation Note
4200 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4201 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4202 @end quotation
4203 @end deffn
4204
4205 @anchor{autoprobing}
4206 @section Autoprobing
4207 @cindex autoprobe
4208 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4209
4210 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4211 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4212 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4213 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4214
4215 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4216 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4217 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4218 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4219 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4220 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4221 right when they come out of reset).
4222
4223 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4224
4225 @example
4226 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4227 reset_config trst_and_srst
4228 jtag_rclk 8
4229 @end example
4230
4231 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4232 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4233
4234 @enumerate
4235 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4236 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4237 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4238 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4239 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4240 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4241 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4242 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4243 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4244 that is discovered.
4245 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4246 register, it will report it.
4247 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4248 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4249 @end enumerate
4250
4251 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4252 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4253 that's a bit more complex:
4254
4255 @example
4256 clock speed 8 kHz
4257 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4258 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4259 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4260 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4261 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4262 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4263 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4264 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4265 @end example
4266
4267 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4268 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4269 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4270 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4271 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4272 and so forth.
4273
4274 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4275 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4276 @cindex DAP declaration
4277
4278 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4279 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4280 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4281 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4282 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4283
4284 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4285
4286 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4287 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4288 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4289 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4290 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4291
4292 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4293
4294 @itemize @bullet
4295 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4296 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4297 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4298 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4299 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4300 @end itemize
4301 @end deffn
4302
4303 @deffn Command {dap names}
4304 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4305 for TCL scripting.
4306 @end deffn
4307
4308 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4309 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4310 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4311 @end deffn
4312
4313 @deffn Command {dap init}
4314 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4315 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4316 initialization, too.
4317 @end deffn
4318
4319 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4320
4321 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4322 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4323 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4324 @end deffn
4325
4326 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4327 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4328 @end deffn
4329
4330 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4331 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4332 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4333 or set a new value @var{value}.
4334 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4335 @end deffn
4336
4337 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4338 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4339 @end deffn
4340
4341 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4342 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4343 value @var{value}.
4344
4345 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4346 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4347 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4348
4349 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4350 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4351 @end deffn
4352
4353 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4354 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4355 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4356 @end deffn
4357
4358 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4359 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4360 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4361 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4362 @end deffn
4363
4364 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4365 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4366
4367 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4368 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4369 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4370 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4371 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4372 for details.
4373
4374 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4375 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4376 the pattern:
4377 @example
4378 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4379 @end example
4380
4381 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4382 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4383 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4384 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4385 @example
4386 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4387 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4388 @end example
4389
4390 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4391 @example
4392 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4393 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4394 @end example
4395
4396 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4397 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4398
4399 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4400 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4401 example with a proper dap name:
4402 @example
4403 xxx.dap apcsw default
4404 @end example
4405 @end deffn
4406
4407 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4408 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4409 Disabled by default
4410 @end deffn
4411
4412
4413 @node CPU Configuration
4414 @chapter CPU Configuration
4415 @cindex GDB target
4416
4417 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4418 You can also access these targets without GDB
4419 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4420 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4421 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4422 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4423
4424 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4425 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4426
4427 @section Target List
4428 @cindex target, current
4429 @cindex target, list
4430
4431 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4432 where each member has a name.
4433 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4434 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4435 (plural!) command.
4436 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4437 look like with more than one:
4438 @verbatim
4439 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4440 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4441 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4442 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4443 @end verbatim
4444
4445 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4446 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4447 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4448 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4449 space seen by that current target.
4450 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4451 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4452 are examples; and there are many more.
4453
4454 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4455
4456 @deffn Command {target current}
4457 Returns the name of the current target.
4458 @end deffn
4459
4460 @deffn Command {target names}
4461 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4462 @example
4463 foreach t [target names] @{
4464 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4465 @}
4466 @end example
4467 @end deffn
4468
4469 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4470 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4471
4472 @deffn Command targets [name]
4473 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4474 command names are singular.}
4475
4476 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4477 targets in a user friendly form.
4478
4479 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4480 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4481 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4482 @end deffn
4483
4484 @section Target CPU Types
4485 @cindex target type
4486 @cindex CPU type
4487
4488 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4489 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4490 when calling @command{target create}.
4491 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4492 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4493 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4494 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4495 what core-specific commands may be available
4496 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4497 and more.
4498
4499 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4500 since there's a command to list them.
4501
4502 @anchor{targettypes}
4503 @deffn Command {target types}
4504 Lists all supported target types.
4505 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4506
4507 @itemize @bullet
4508 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4509 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4510 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4511 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4512 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4513 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4514 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4515 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4516 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4517 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4518 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4519 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4520 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4521 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4522 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4523 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4524 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4525 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4526 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4527 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4528 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4529 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4530 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4531 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4532 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4533 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4534 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4535 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4536 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4537 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4538 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4539 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4540 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4541 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4542 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4543 @itemize @minus
4544 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4545 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4546 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4547 @end itemize
4548 And two debug interfaces cores:
4549 @itemize @minus
4550 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4551 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4552 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4553 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4554 @end itemize
4555 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4556 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4557 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4558 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4559 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4560 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4561 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4562 @end itemize
4563 @end deffn
4564
4565 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4566 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4567 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4568 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4569 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4570 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4571 reflect design generations;
4572 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4573 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4574
4575 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4576 @section Target Configuration
4577
4578 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4579 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4580 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4581 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4582 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4583
4584 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4585 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4586 optional parts.
4587 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4588 command, created as part of target creation.
4589
4590 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4591 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4592 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4593 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4594 to be much more board-specific.
4595 The key steps you use might look something like this
4596
4597 @example
4598 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4599 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4600 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4601 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4602 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4603 @end example
4604
4605 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4606 on-chip SRAM.
4607 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4608 writes to target memory;
4609 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4610 GDB memory checksumming;
4611 and more.
4612
4613 @quotation Warning
4614 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4615 inaccessible when application code
4616 (such as an operating system)
4617 enables or disables the MMU.
4618 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4619 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4620 easy access to other addresses needed.
4621 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4622 @end quotation
4623
4624 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4625 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4626 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4627 controllers.
4628 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4629 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4630 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4631
4632 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4633 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4634 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4635 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4636 purposes including additional configuration.
4637
4638 @itemize @bullet
4639 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4640 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4641 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4642 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4643
4644 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4645 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4646 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4647 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4648 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4649 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4650 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4651
4652 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4653 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4654 @end itemize
4655 @end deffn
4656
4657 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4658 The options accepted by this command may also be
4659 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4660 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4661 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4662
4663 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4664 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4665 and changing its endianness.
4666
4667 @itemize @bullet
4668
4669 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4670 used to access this target.
4671
4672 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4673 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4674 create and manage DAP instances.
4675
4676 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4677 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4678
4679 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4680 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4681 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4682 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4683 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4684 same event name assigns only one handler.
4685
4686 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4687 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4688
4689 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4690 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4691 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4692 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4693 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4694 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4695 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4696
4697 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4698 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4699 or virtual address is being used.
4700
4701 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4702 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4703
4704 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4705 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4706 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4707 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4708 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4709
4710 @anchor{rtostype}
4711 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4712 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4713 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4714 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4715 @option{RIOT}
4716 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4717
4718 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4719 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4720 access the target for debugging.
4721
4722 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4723 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4724 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4725 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4726
4727 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4728 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4729 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4730 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4731 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4732
4733 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4734 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4735 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4736 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4737 command @command{gdb_port}.
4738 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4739
4740 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4741 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4742 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4743 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4744 @end itemize
4745 @end deffn
4746
4747 @section Other $target_name Commands
4748 @cindex object command
4749
4750 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4751 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4752
4753 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4754 Once a button is created a button
4755 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4756 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4757 configure it like this:
4758
4759 @example
4760 # Create
4761 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4762 # Modify
4763 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4764 # Query
4765 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4766 # Report
4767 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4768 @end example
4769
4770 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4771 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4772
4773 @example
4774 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4775 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4776 @end example
4777
4778 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4779
4780 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4781 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4782 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4783 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4784 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4785 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4786 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4787 They are not otherwise documented here.
4788 @end deffn
4789
4790 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4791 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4792 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4793 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4794 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4795 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4796 the target side uses raw memory.
4797
4798 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4799 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4800 The script orientation comes from working with data
4801 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4802 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4803 and neither store nor return those values.
4804
4805 @itemize
4806 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4807 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4808 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4809 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4810 @end itemize
4811 @end deffn
4812
4813 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4814 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4815 @command{$target_name configure}
4816 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4817 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4818 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4819 There are a few special cases:
4820
4821 @itemize @bullet
4822 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4823 event named @var{event_name}.
4824 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4825 two parameters.
4826 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4827 This is a special case because this is set using
4828 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4829 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4830 @end itemize
4831
4832 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4833 all the targets you might use something like this:
4834
4835 @example
4836 foreach name [target names] @{
4837 set y [$name cget -endian]
4838 set z [$name cget -type]
4839 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4840 $x $name $y $z]
4841 @}
4842 @end example
4843 @end deffn
4844
4845 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4846 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4847 Displays the current target state:
4848 @code{debug-running},
4849 @code{halted},
4850 @code{reset},
4851 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4852 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4853 @end deffn
4854
4855 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4856 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4857 currently associated with this target.
4858 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4859 @end deffn
4860
4861 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4862 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4863 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4864 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4865 @end deffn
4866
4867 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4868 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4869 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4870 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4871 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4872 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4873 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4874 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4875 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4876 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4877 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4878 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4879 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4880 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4881 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4882 @end deffn
4883
4884 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4885 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4886 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4887 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4888 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4889 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4890 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4891 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4892 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4893 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4894 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4895 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4896 @end deffn
4897
4898 @anchor{targetevents}
4899 @section Target Events
4900 @cindex target events
4901 @cindex events
4902 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4903 For example:
4904 @itemize @bullet
4905 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4906 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4907 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4908 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4909 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4910 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4911 to set up system clocks or
4912 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4913 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4914 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4915 @end itemize
4916
4917 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4918 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4919 @command{target create ... -event}.
4920
4921 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4922 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4923 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4924
4925 @example
4926 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4927 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4928 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4929 @}
4930 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4931 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4932 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4933 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4934 @}
4935 @end example
4936
4937 The following target events are defined:
4938
4939 @itemize @bullet
4940 @item @b{debug-halted}
4941 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4942 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4943 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4944 @item @b{early-halted}
4945 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4946 @item @b{examine-start}
4947 @* Before target examine is called.
4948 @item @b{examine-end}
4949 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4950 @item @b{examine-fail}
4951 @* After target examine fails.
4952 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4953 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4954 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4955 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4956 connect GDB to running target.
4957 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4958 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4959 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4960 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4961 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4962 is in RAM or read only memory.
4963 Default is @code{halt}
4964 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4965 @* When GDB disconnects
4966 @item @b{gdb-end}
4967 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4968 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4969 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4970 @code{reset init})
4971 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4972 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4973 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4974 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4975 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4976 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4977 @item @b{gdb-start}
4978 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4979 @item @b{halted}
4980 @* The target has halted
4981 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4982 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4983 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4984 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4985 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4986 @item @b{reset-assert}
4987 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4988 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4989 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4990 it instead of asserting SRST.
4991 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4992 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4993 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4994 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4995 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4996 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4997 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4998 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4999 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5000 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5001 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5002 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5003 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5004 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5005 released on the scan chain.
5006 @item @b{reset-end}
5007 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5008 @item @b{reset-init}
5009 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5010 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5011
5012 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5013 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5014 multiplexing, and so on.
5015 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5016 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5017 @item @b{reset-start}
5018 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5019 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5020
5021 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5022 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5023 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5024 @item @b{resume-start}
5025 @* Before any target is resumed
5026 @item @b{resume-end}
5027 @* After all targets have resumed
5028 @item @b{resumed}
5029 @* Target has resumed
5030 @item @b{step-start}
5031 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5032 @item @b{step-end}
5033 @* After single-step has completed
5034 @item @b{trace-config}
5035 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5036 @end itemize
5037
5038 @quotation Note
5039 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5040 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5041 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5042 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5043 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5044 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5045 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5046 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5047 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5048 check if the core has changed status.
5049 @end quotation
5050
5051 @node Flash Commands
5052 @chapter Flash Commands
5053
5054 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5055 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5056 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5057 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5058 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5059 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5060 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5061 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5062 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5063
5064 Flash Steps:
5065 @enumerate
5066 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5067 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5068 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5069 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5070 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5071 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5072 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5073 @item GDB Flashing
5074 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5075 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5076 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5077 @end enumerate
5078
5079 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5080 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5081 so that it can't boot.
5082 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5083 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5084
5085 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5086 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5087 @cindex flash configuration
5088
5089 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5090 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5091 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5092 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5093 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5094 see the driver-specific documentation.
5095
5096 @itemize @bullet
5097 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5098 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5099 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5100 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5101 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5102 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5103 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5104 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5105 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5106 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5107 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5108 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5109 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5110 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5111 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5112 commands to the flash controller.
5113 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5114 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5115 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5116 for more information.
5117 @end itemize
5118 @quotation Note
5119 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5120 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5121 @end quotation
5122 @end deffn
5123
5124 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5125 @deffn Command {flash banks}
5126 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5127 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5128 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5129 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5130 @end deffn
5131
5132 @deffn Command {flash list}
5133 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5134 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5135 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5136 @end deffn
5137
5138 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
5139 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5140 depends on the flash type.
5141 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5142 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5143 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5144 but most don't bother.
5145 @end deffn
5146
5147 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5148
5149 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5150 begins.
5151
5152 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5153 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5154 until the programming session is finished.
5155
5156 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5157 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5158
5159 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5160
5161 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5162 @cindex flash erasing
5163 @cindex flash reading
5164 @cindex flash writing
5165 @cindex flash programming
5166 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5167
5168 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5169 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5170 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5171 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5172 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5173
5174 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5175 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5176 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5177 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5178 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5179
5180 @quotation Note
5181 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5182 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5183 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5184 back to a flash bank.
5185 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5186 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5187 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5188 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5189 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5190 @end quotation
5191
5192 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5193 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5194 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5195 disabled first.
5196 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5197 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5198 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5199
5200 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5201 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5202 up to and including @var{last}.
5203 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5204 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5205 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5206 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5207 @end deffn
5208
5209 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5210 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5211 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5212 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5213 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5214 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5215 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5216 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5217 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5218 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5219 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5220 before erase starts.
5221 @end deffn
5222
5223 @deffn Command {flash filld} address double-word length
5224 @deffnx Command {flash fillw} address word length
5225 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5226 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5227 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5228 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5229 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5230 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5231 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5232 before issuing this command.
5233 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5234 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5235 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5236 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5237 @end deffn
5238 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5239
5240 @deffn Command {flash mdw} addr [count]
5241 @deffnx Command {flash mdh} addr [count]
5242 @deffnx Command {flash mdb} addr [count]
5243 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5244 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5245 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5246 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5247 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5248 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5249 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5250 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5251 @end deffn
5252
5253 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5254 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5255 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5256 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5257 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5258 @end deffn
5259
5260 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5261 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5262 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5263 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5264 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5265 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5266 @end deffn
5267
5268 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5269 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5270 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5271 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5272 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5273 @end deffn
5274
5275 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5276 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5277 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5278 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5279 to the base address for each section in the image.
5280 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5281 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5282 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5283 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5284 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5285 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5286 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5287 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5288 each image section.
5289
5290 @quotation Warning
5291 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5292 data you want to preserve.
5293 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5294 sections might be erased with no notice.
5295 @itemize
5296 @item
5297 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5298 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5299 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5300 @item
5301 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5302 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5303 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5304 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5305 @end itemize
5306 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5307 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5308 @end quotation
5309
5310 @end deffn
5311
5312 @deffn Command {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5313 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5314 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5315 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5316 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5317 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5318 ordinary memory reads.
5319 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5320 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5321 check for successful programming.
5322 @end deffn
5323
5324 @section Other Flash commands
5325 @cindex flash protection
5326
5327 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5328 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5329 and display that status.
5330 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5331 @end deffn
5332
5333 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5334 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5335 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5336
5337 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5338 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5339 and possibly stale information.
5340 @end deffn
5341
5342 @anchor{flashprotect}
5343 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5344 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5345 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5346 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5347 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5348 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5349 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5350 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5351 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5352 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5353 @end deffn
5354
5355 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5356 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5357 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5358 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5359 @end deffn
5360
5361 @anchor{program}
5362 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5363 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5364 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5365 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5366 @end deffn
5367
5368 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5369 @section Flash Driver List
5370 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5371 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5372 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5373
5374 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5375 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5376 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5377
5378 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5379
5380 @itemize
5381 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5382 @end itemize
5383
5384 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5385 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5386 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5387 @example
5388 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5389 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5390 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5391 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5392 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5393 @end example
5394 @end deffn
5395
5396 @subsection External Flash
5397
5398 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5399 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5400 @cindex CFI
5401 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5402 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5403 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5404 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5405 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5406 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5407 configure a bus and its timings), or
5408 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5409 on the flash chip.
5410 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5411 speed up operation.
5412
5413 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5414
5415 @itemize
5416 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5417 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5418 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5419 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5420 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5421 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5422 @end itemize
5423
5424 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5425 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5426
5427 @example
5428 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5429 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5430 @end example
5431
5432 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5433 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5434 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5435
5436 @example
5437 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5438 @end example
5439
5440 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5441 @end deffn
5442
5443 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5444 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5445 @cindex SPI
5446 @cindex jtagspi
5447 @cindex bscan_spi
5448 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5449 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5450 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5451 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5452 accessed through JTAG.
5453
5454 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5455 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5456 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5457 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5458 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5459 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5460
5461 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5462 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5463 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5464 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5465 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5466 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5467 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5468 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5469
5470 @itemize
5471 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5472 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5473 @var{USER1} instruction.
5474 @end itemize
5475
5476 @example
5477 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5478 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5479 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5480 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5481 @end example
5482 @end deffn
5483
5484 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5485 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5486 @cindex xcf
5487 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5488 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5489 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5490 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5491 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5492
5493 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5494 command accepts additional parameters:
5495 @itemize
5496 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5497 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5498 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5499 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5500 in master mode.
5501 @end itemize
5502 @example
5503 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5504 @end example
5505 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5506 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5507 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5508 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5509 dedicated sector.
5510 @end deffn
5511
5512 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5513 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5514 button.
5515 @example
5516 xcf configure 0
5517 @end example
5518 @end deffn
5519
5520 Additional driver notes:
5521 @itemize
5522 @item Only single revision supported.
5523 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5524 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5525 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5526 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5527 @end itemize
5528 @end deffn
5529
5530 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5531 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5532 @cindex SPIFI
5533 @cindex lpcspifi
5534 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5535 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5536 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5537
5538 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5539 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5540 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5541 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5542 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5543
5544 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5545 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5546 are configured by the driver.
5547
5548 @example
5549 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5550 @end example
5551
5552 @end deffn
5553
5554 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5555 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5556 @cindex SMI
5557 @cindex stmsmi
5558 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5559 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5560 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5561 SPI flash devices.
5562 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5563 flash devices can be connected.
5564
5565 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5566 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5567 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5568 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5569 the flash content.
5570
5571 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5572 to identify the memory bank.
5573 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5574 flash size, are detected automatically.
5575
5576 @example
5577 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5578 @end example
5579
5580 @end deffn
5581
5582 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmqspi
5583 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5584 @cindex QuadSPI
5585 @cindex OctoSPI
5586 @cindex stmqspi
5587 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5588 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5589 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5590 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5591 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5592 mode is not.
5593
5594 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5595 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5596 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5597 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5598
5599 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5600 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5601 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5602
5603 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5604 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5605 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5606 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5607 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5608 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5609
5610 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5611 but only after proper controller initialization as decribed above. However,
5612 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5613 should be avoided.
5614
5615 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5616 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5617 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5618 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5619 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5620 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5621
5622 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5623 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5624 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5625 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5626 persist across openocd invocations.
5627
5628 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5629 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5630 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5631 required (see 'set' command).
5632
5633 @example
5634 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5635 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5636 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5637 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5638 @end example
5639
5640 There are three specific commands
5641 @deffn Command {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5642 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5643 chip specific write protection engaged.
5644 @end deffn
5645
5646 @deffn Command {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5647 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5648 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5649 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5650 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5651 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5652
5653 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5654 which don't support an id command.
5655
5656 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5657 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5658 @end deffn
5659
5660 @deffn Command {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5661 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5662 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5663 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5664 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5665
5666 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5667 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5668 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5669 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5670
5671 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5672
5673 To check basic communication settings, issue
5674 @example
5675 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5676 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5677 @end example
5678 for single flash mode or
5679 @example
5680 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5681 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5682 @end example
5683 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5684
5685 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5686 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5687 need a dummy address, e.g.
5688 @example
5689 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5690 @end example
5691 should return the status register contents.
5692
5693 @end deffn
5694
5695 @end deffn
5696
5697 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5698 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5699 Microcontroller platform.
5700
5701 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5702 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5703
5704 @example
5705 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5706 @end example
5707
5708 @end deffn
5709
5710 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5711 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5712 @cindex ath79
5713 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5714 chip selects.
5715 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5716 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5717 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5718 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5719 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5720 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5721
5722 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5723 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5724 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5725 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5726 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5727 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5728 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5729 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5730 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5731 with the default CS0.
5732 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5733 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5734 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5735
5736 @example
5737 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5738
5739 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5740 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5741 # distinguish the banks.
5742 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5743 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5744 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5745 @end example
5746
5747 @end deffn
5748
5749 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5750 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5751 @cindex fespi
5752
5753 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5754
5755 @example
5756 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5757 @end example
5758 @end deffn
5759
5760 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5761
5762 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5763 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5764 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5765 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5766 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5767 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5768
5769 @example
5770 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5771 @end example
5772 @end deffn
5773
5774 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5775 @cindex ambiqmicro
5776 @cindex apollo
5777 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5778 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5779 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5780 with the target using SWD.
5781
5782 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5783 the device class of the MCU.
5784 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5785 to set up the flash banks.
5786 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5787 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5788
5789 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5790 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5791 and the second bank starts after the first.
5792
5793 @example
5794 # Flash bank 0
5795 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5796 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5797 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5798 $_TARGETNAME
5799 @end example
5800
5801 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5802 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5803 are available to the user.
5804
5805 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5806
5807 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5808 Erase entire bank.
5809 @end deffn
5810 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5811 Erase device pages.
5812 @end deffn
5813 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5814 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5815 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5816 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5817 the flash.
5818 @end deffn
5819 @end deffn
5820
5821 @anchor{at91samd}
5822 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5823 @cindex at91samd
5824 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5825 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5826
5827 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5828
5829 The devices have one flash bank:
5830
5831 @example
5832 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5833 @end example
5834
5835 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5836 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5837 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5838 processor to be halted.
5839 @end deffn
5840
5841 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5842 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5843 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5844 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5845 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5846 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5847
5848 @example
5849 at91samd set-security enable
5850 @end example
5851 @end deffn
5852
5853 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5854 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5855 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5856 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5857 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5858 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5859 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5860 in order to disable this feature.
5861
5862 @example
5863 at91samd eeprom
5864 at91samd eeprom 1024
5865 @end example
5866 @end deffn
5867
5868 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5869 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5870 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5871 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5872 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5873 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5874
5875 @example
5876 at91samd bootloader
5877 at91samd bootloader 16384
5878 @end example
5879 @end deffn
5880
5881 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5882 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5883 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5884 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5885 @end deffn
5886
5887 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5888 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5889 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5890 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5891 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5892 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5893 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5894 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5895
5896 @example
5897 # Read user row
5898 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5899 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5900 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5901 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5902 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
5903 # byte unchanged
5904 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5905 @end example
5906 @end deffn
5907
5908 @end deffn
5909
5910 @anchor{at91sam3}
5911 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5912 @cindex at91sam3
5913 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5914 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5915 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5916 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5917 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5918 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5919 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5920 chips are confirmed.}
5921
5922 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5923 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5924 the following fixed locations:
5925
5926 @example
5927 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5928 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5929 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5930 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5931 @end example
5932
5933 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5934 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5935 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5936
5937 @itemize
5938 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5939 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5940 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5941 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5942 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5943 @end itemize
5944
5945 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5946
5947 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5948 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5949 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5950 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5951 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5952 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5953 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5954
5955 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5956 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5957 @end deffn
5958
5959 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5960 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5961 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5962 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5963 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5964 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5965 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5966 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5967 @end deffn
5968
5969 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5970 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5971 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5972 @end deffn
5973 @end deffn
5974
5975 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5976 @cindex at91sam4
5977 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5978 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5979 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5980 @end deffn
5981
5982 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5983 @cindex at91sam4l
5984 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5985 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5986 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5987
5988 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5989 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5990 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5991 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5992 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5993 @end deffn
5994 @end deffn
5995
5996 @anchor{atsame5}
5997 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5998 @cindex atsame5
5999 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6000 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6001 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6002
6003 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6004 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6005 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6006
6007 @example
6008 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6009 @end example
6010
6011 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
6012 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6013 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6014 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6015 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6016 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6017
6018 @example
6019 atsame5 bootloader
6020 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6021 @end example
6022 @end deffn
6023
6024 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
6025 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6026 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6027 processor to be halted.
6028 @end deffn
6029
6030 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6031 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6032 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6033 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6034 @end deffn
6035
6036 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
6037 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6038 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6039 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6040 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6041 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6042 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6043 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6044
6045 @example
6046 # Read
6047 >atsame5 userpage
6048 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6049 # Write
6050 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6051 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6052 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6053 # bytes)
6054 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6055 @end example
6056 @end deffn
6057
6058 @end deffn
6059
6060 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
6061 @cindex atsamv
6062 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6063 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6064 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6065 @end deffn
6066
6067 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
6068 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6069 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6070 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6071 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6072
6073 @example
6074 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6075 @end example
6076
6077 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6078 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6079
6080 @itemize
6081 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6082 @item @var{banks}
6083 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6084 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6085 @item @var{pages_size}
6086 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6087 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6088 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6089 @end itemize
6090
6091 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6092 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6093 will be autoconfigured.
6094 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6095
6096 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6097 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6098 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6099 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6100 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6101
6102 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6103 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6104 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6105 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6106 are not truly general purpose).
6107 @quotation Note
6108 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6109 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6110 @end quotation
6111 @end deffn
6112 @end deffn
6113
6114 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
6115 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6116 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6117 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6118 @end deffn
6119
6120 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
6121 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6122 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6123 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6124
6125 @example
6126 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6127 @end example
6128
6129 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6130 each single sector one by one.
6131
6132 @example
6133 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6134 @end example
6135
6136 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6137 @end deffn
6138
6139 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
6140 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6141 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6142 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6143 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6144 starts at address 0.
6145
6146 @example
6147 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6148 @end example
6149 @end deffn
6150
6151 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
6152 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6153 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6154 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6155 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6156 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6157 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6158 and programming the serial flash.
6159
6160 @example
6161 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6162 @end example
6163 @end deffn
6164
6165 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
6166 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6167 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6168 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6169 autoconfigures itself.
6170 @example
6171 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6172 @end example
6173 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6174 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6175 this via the following command:
6176 @example
6177 efm32 debuglock num
6178 @end example
6179 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6180 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6181 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6182 supported.}
6183 @end deffn
6184
6185 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
6186 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6187 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6188 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6189 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6190 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6191
6192 @example
6193 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6194 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6195 @end example
6196
6197 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6198 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6199 @end deffn
6200
6201 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6202 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6203 is an uncommon operation.}
6204 @end deffn
6205 @end deffn
6206
6207 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
6208 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6209 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6210 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6211 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6212 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6213 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6214
6215 @example
6216 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6217 @end example
6218 @end deffn
6219
6220 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
6221 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6222 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6223 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6224 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6225 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6226 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6227 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6228 characters) ignored.
6229
6230 @example
6231 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6232 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6233 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6234 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6235 @end example
6236 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6237 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6238 @end deffn
6239
6240 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
6241 @cindex kinetis
6242 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6243 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6244 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6245 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6246 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6247 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6248
6249 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6250 @itemize
6251 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6252 @end itemize
6253
6254 @example
6255 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6256 @end example
6257
6258 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
6259 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6260 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6261 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6262 @end deffn
6263
6264 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6265 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6266 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6267 set by 'flash protect' command.
6268 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6269 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6270 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6271 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6272 with the rest of a flash image.
6273 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6274 @end deffn
6275
6276 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
6277 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6278 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6279 @end deffn
6280
6281 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
6282 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6283 and examine-fail event.
6284 @end deffn
6285
6286 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
6287 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6288 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6289 @end deffn
6290
6291 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6292 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6293 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6294 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6295 command completes.
6296 @end deffn
6297
6298 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
6299 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6300 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6301 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6302 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6303
6304 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6305 Program Partition command.
6306
6307 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6308 Reset the device after partition setting.
6309
6310 Show partition size:
6311 @example
6312 kinetis nvm_partition info
6313 @end example
6314
6315 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6316 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6317 @example
6318 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6319 @end example
6320
6321 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6322 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6323 @example
6324 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6325 @end example
6326 @end deffn
6327
6328 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6329 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6330 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6331 @end deffn
6332
6333 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6334 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6335 Command disables watchdog timer.
6336 @end deffn
6337 @end deffn
6338
6339 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6340 @cindex kinetis_ke
6341 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6342 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6343 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6344 autoconfigures itself.
6345 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6346
6347 @example
6348 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6349 @end example
6350
6351 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6352 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6353 @end deffn
6354
6355 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6356 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6357 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6358 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6359 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6360 @end deffn
6361
6362 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6363 Command disables watchdog timer.
6364 @end deffn
6365 @end deffn
6366
6367 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6368 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6369 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6370 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6371 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6372
6373 @quotation Note
6374 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6375 driver:
6376 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6377 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6378 @end quotation
6379
6380 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6381 which must appear in the following order:
6382
6383 @itemize
6384 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6385 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6386 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6387 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6388 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6389 LPC43x[2357])
6390 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6391 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6392 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6393 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6394 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6395 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6396 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6397 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6398 at which the core is running
6399 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6400 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6401 @quotation Note
6402 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6403 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6404 However, if you do provide it,
6405 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6406 @end quotation
6407 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6408 ROM IAP entry point.
6409 @end itemize
6410
6411 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6412
6413 @example
6414 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6415 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6416 @end example
6417
6418 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6419 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6420 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6421 @end deffn
6422 @end deffn
6423
6424 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6425 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6426 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6427 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6428 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6429 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6430
6431 @example
6432 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6433 @end example
6434 @end deffn
6435
6436 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6437 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6438 from NXP.
6439
6440 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6441 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6442 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6443 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6444 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6445 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6446 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6447 you start the PLL.
6448
6449 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6450
6451 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6452 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6453 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6454
6455 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6456 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6457 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6458 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6459 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6460 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6461 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6462
6463 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6464 @example
6465 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6466 @end example
6467
6468 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6469 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6470 @code{flash banks} command.
6471
6472 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6473 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6474 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6475 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6476 a known signature.
6477 Example:
6478 @example
6479 lpc2900 signature 0
6480 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6481 @end example
6482 @end deffn
6483
6484 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6485 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6486 saves it to a file in binary format.
6487 Example:
6488 @example
6489 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6490 @end example
6491 @end deffn
6492
6493 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6494 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6495 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6496 command:
6497
6498 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6499 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6500 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6501 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6502
6503 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6504 Example:
6505 @example
6506 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6507 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6508 @end example
6509 @end deffn
6510
6511 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6512 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6513 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6514 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6515 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6516 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6517 912 bytes.
6518 @quotation Attention
6519 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6520 @end quotation
6521 Example:
6522 @example
6523 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6524 @end example
6525 @end deffn
6526
6527 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6528 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6529 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6530 after the next power cycle.
6531 @quotation Attention
6532 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6533 @end quotation
6534 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6535 Example:
6536 @example
6537 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6538 flash info 0
6539 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6540 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6541 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6542 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6543 @end example
6544 @end deffn
6545
6546 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6547 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6548 effective after the next power cycle.
6549 @quotation Attention
6550 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6551 @end quotation
6552 Examples:
6553 @example
6554 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6555 @end example
6556 @end deffn
6557 @end deffn
6558
6559 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6560 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6561 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6562 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6563
6564 @example
6565 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6566 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6567 @end example
6568
6569 @itemize @bullet
6570 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6571 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6572 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6573 @end itemize
6574
6575 Example usage:
6576 @example
6577 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6578 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6579 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6580 @} else @{
6581 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6582 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6583 @}
6584 @end example
6585 @end deffn
6586
6587 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6588 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6589 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6590 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6591 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6592 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6593
6594 @example
6595 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6596 @end example
6597
6598 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6599 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6600 only the main program flash.
6601
6602 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6603 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6604 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6605 @end deffn
6606
6607 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6608 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6609 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6610 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6611
6612 To erase and program the BSL:
6613 @example
6614 msp432 bsl unlock
6615 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6616 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6617 msp432 bsl lock
6618 @end example
6619 @end deffn
6620 @end deffn
6621
6622 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6623 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6624 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6625 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6626 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6627 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6628 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6629 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6630 also have division into regions: main and info.
6631 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6632 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6633
6634 @example
6635 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6636 @end example
6637
6638 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6639
6640 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6641 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6642 @end deffn
6643
6644 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6645 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6646 @end deffn
6647
6648 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6649 Erase all userflash including info region.
6650 @end deffn
6651
6652 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6653 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6654 @end deffn
6655
6656 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6657 Check sectors protect.
6658 @end deffn
6659
6660 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6661 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6662 @end deffn
6663
6664 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6665 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6666 @end deffn
6667
6668 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6669 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6670 @end deffn
6671
6672 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6673 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6674 @end deffn
6675
6676 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6677 Show information about flash driver.
6678 @end deffn
6679
6680 @end deffn
6681
6682 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6683 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6684 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6685 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6686 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6687
6688 @example
6689 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6690 @end example
6691
6692 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6693
6694 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6695 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6696 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6697 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6698 code.
6699 @end deffn
6700
6701 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6702 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6703 @end deffn
6704
6705 @end deffn
6706
6707 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6708 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6709 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6710
6711 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6712 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6713 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6714 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6715
6716 @example
6717 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6718 @end example
6719 @end deffn
6720
6721 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6722 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6723 and integrate flash memory.
6724
6725 @example
6726 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6727 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6728 @end example
6729
6730 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6731 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6732 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6733 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6734 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6735 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6736 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6737 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6738 @end deffn
6739 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6740 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6741 This will remove any Code Protection.
6742 @end deffn
6743 @end deffn
6744
6745 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6746 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6747 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6748 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6749 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6750
6751 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6752 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6753
6754 @example
6755 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6756 @end example
6757
6758 psoc4-specific commands
6759 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6760 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6761
6762 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6763 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6764
6765 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6766 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6767 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6768
6769 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6770 @end deffn
6771
6772 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6773 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6774
6775 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6776 @end deffn
6777 @end deffn
6778
6779 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6780 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6781 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6782 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6783 apart from the base address.
6784
6785 @example
6786 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6787 @end example
6788
6789 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6790 @quotation Attention
6791 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6792 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6793 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6794 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6795 @end quotation
6796
6797 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6798
6799 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6800 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6801 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6802 @end deffn
6803 @end deffn
6804
6805 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6806 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6807 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6808 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6809 apart from the base address.
6810
6811 @example
6812 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6813 $_TARGETNAME
6814 @end example
6815 @end deffn
6816
6817 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6818 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6819 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6820 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6821
6822 @example
6823 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6824 @end example
6825
6826 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6827
6828 @itemize
6829 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6830 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6831 @end itemize
6832
6833 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6834
6835 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6836 @quotation Attention
6837 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6838 after successful write.
6839 @end quotation
6840 @end deffn
6841
6842 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6843 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6844 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6845 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6846
6847 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6848 @itemize @bullet
6849 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6850 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6851 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6852 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6853 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6854 row size: 512 bytes.
6855 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6856 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6857 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6858 operation will erase row automatically.
6859 @end itemize
6860
6861 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6862 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6863
6864 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6865
6866 @example
6867 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6868 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6869 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6870 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6871 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6872 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6873 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6874 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6875 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6876 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6877 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6878 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6879
6880 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6881 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6882 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6883 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6884 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6885 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6886 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6887 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6888 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6889 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6890 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6891 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6892 @end example
6893
6894 psoc6-specific commands
6895 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6896 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6897 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6898 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6899 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6900 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6901 @end deffn
6902
6903 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6904 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6905 by @command{flash banks}.
6906 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6907 @end deffn
6908 @end deffn
6909
6910 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6911 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6912 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6913 and SWD interface.
6914 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6915 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6916
6917 @example
6918 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6919 @end example
6920
6921 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6922
6923 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6924 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6925 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6926 @end deffn
6927
6928 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6929 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6930 @end deffn
6931 @end deffn
6932
6933 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6934 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6935 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6936 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6937 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6938
6939 @example
6940 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6941 @end example
6942
6943 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6944 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6945 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6946 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6947 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6948 disabled.
6949
6950 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6951 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6952 @quotation Warning
6953 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6954 applied to all of them.
6955 @end quotation
6956 @end deffn
6957 @end deffn
6958
6959 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6960 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6961 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6962 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6963 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6964
6965 @example
6966 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6967 @end example
6968
6969 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6970 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6971 the flash driver.
6972
6973 @example
6974 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6975 @end example
6976
6977 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6978 as per the following example.
6979 @example
6980 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6981 @end example
6982
6983 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6984
6985 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6986 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6987 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6988 @end deffn
6989
6990 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6991 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6992 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6993 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6994 @end deffn
6995
6996 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6997 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6998 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6999 @end deffn
7000
7001 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
7002 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7003 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7004 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7005 @end deffn
7006
7007 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7008 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7009 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7010 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7011 @end deffn
7012
7013 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
7014 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7015 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7016 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7017 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7018 @end deffn
7019 @end deffn
7020
7021 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
7022 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7023 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7024 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7025 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7026
7027 @example
7028 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7029 @end example
7030
7031 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7032 as per the following example.
7033 @example
7034 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7035 @end example
7036
7037 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7038 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7039 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7040 @end deffn
7041
7042 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7043 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7044 the flash driver.
7045
7046 @example
7047 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7048 @end example
7049
7050 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7051
7052 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
7053 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7054 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7055 @end deffn
7056
7057 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
7058 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7059 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7060 @end deffn
7061
7062 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7063 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7064 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7065 @end deffn
7066
7067 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
7068 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7069 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7070 @end deffn
7071
7072 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7073 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7074 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7075 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7076 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7077 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7078 @end deffn
7079
7080 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7081 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7082 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7083 @end deffn
7084 @end deffn
7085
7086 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
7087 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7088 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7089 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7090 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7091
7092 @example
7093 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7094 @end example
7095
7096 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7097 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7098 the flash driver.
7099
7100 @example
7101 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7102 @end example
7103
7104 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7105
7106 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
7107 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7108 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7109 @end deffn
7110
7111 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
7112 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7113 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7114 @end deffn
7115
7116 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7117 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7118 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7119 @end deffn
7120
7121 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7122 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7123 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7124 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7125 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7126
7127 Example usage:
7128 @example
7129 # read OPTSR_CUR
7130 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7131 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7132 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7133 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7134 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7135 @end example
7136 @end deffn
7137
7138 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7139 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7140 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7141 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7142 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7143 will be touched).
7144
7145 Example usage:
7146 @example
7147 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7148 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7149 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7150 @end example
7151 @end deffn
7152 @end deffn
7153
7154 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
7155 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7156 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7157 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7158 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7159
7160 @example
7161 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7162 @end example
7163
7164 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7165 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7166 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7167 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7168 second bank.
7169
7170 @example
7171 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7172 @end example
7173
7174 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7175
7176 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
7177 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7178 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7179 @end deffn
7180
7181 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
7182 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7183 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7184 @end deffn
7185
7186 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7187 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7188 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7189 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7190 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7191 @end deffn
7192 @end deffn
7193
7194 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
7195 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, WB and WL
7196 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7197 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7198 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7199 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7200
7201 @example
7202 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7203 @end example
7204
7205 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7206 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7207 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7208 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7209
7210 @example
7211 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7212 @end example
7213
7214 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7215
7216 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
7217 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7218 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7219 @end deffn
7220
7221 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
7222 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7223 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7224 @end deffn
7225
7226 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7227 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7228 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7229 @end deffn
7230
7231 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7232 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7233 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7234 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7235
7236 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7237 @example
7238 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7239 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7240 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7241 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7242 @end example
7243
7244 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7245 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7246 @end deffn
7247
7248 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7249 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7250 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7251 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7252 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7253
7254 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7255 @example
7256 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7257 @end example
7258
7259 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7260 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7261 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7262 @end deffn
7263
7264 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
7265 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7266 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7267 @end deffn
7268 @end deffn
7269
7270 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
7271 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7272 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7273 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7274 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7275
7276 @example
7277 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7278 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7279 @end example
7280
7281 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7282 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7283 for the specified flash bank.
7284 @end deffn
7285 @end deffn
7286
7287 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
7288 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7289 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7290 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7291 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7292
7293 @example
7294 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7295 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7296 @end example
7297
7298 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7299 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7300 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7301
7302 @itemize @bullet
7303 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7304 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7305 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7306 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7307 @end itemize
7308 @end deffn
7309
7310 @end deffn
7311
7312 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7313 @cindex str9xpec
7314
7315 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7316 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7317 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7318 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7319
7320 Here is some background info to help
7321 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7322 the str9:
7323 @enumerate
7324 @item
7325 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7326 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7327 @item
7328 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7329 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7330 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7331 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7332 @end enumerate
7333
7334 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7335 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7336 configured for flash bank 0.
7337 @example
7338 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7339 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7340 adapter assert srst
7341 # turn off target polling
7342 poll off
7343 # disable str9 core
7344 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7345 # read option bytes
7346 str9xpec options_read 0
7347 # re-enable str9 core
7348 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7349 poll on
7350 reset halt
7351 @end example
7352 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7353 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7354 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7355 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7356
7357 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7358
7359 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7360 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7361 @end deffn
7362
7363 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7364 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7365 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7366 @end deffn
7367
7368 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7369 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7370 erase the device.
7371 @end deffn
7372
7373 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7374 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7375 @end deffn
7376
7377 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7378 Configure str9 boot bank.
7379 @end deffn
7380
7381 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7382 Configure str9 lvd source.
7383 @end deffn
7384
7385 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7386 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7387 @end deffn
7388
7389 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7390 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7391 @end deffn
7392
7393 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7394 Read str9 option bytes.
7395 @end deffn
7396
7397 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7398 Write str9 option bytes.
7399 @end deffn
7400
7401 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7402 unlock str9 device.
7403 @end deffn
7404
7405 @end deffn
7406
7407 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7408 @cindex swm050
7409 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7410
7411 @example
7412 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7413 @end example
7414
7415 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7416
7417 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7418 Erases the entire flash bank.
7419 @end deffn
7420
7421 @end deffn
7422
7423
7424 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7425 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7426 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7427 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7428
7429 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7430
7431 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7432 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7433 @end deffn
7434
7435 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7436 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7437 @end deffn
7438
7439 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7440 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7441 the flash clock.
7442 @end deffn
7443 @end deffn
7444
7445 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7446 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7447 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7448 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7449 correct bank config.
7450
7451 @example
7452 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7453 @end example
7454 @end deffn
7455
7456 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7457 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7458 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7459 @end deffn
7460
7461 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7462 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7463 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7464
7465 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7466
7467 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7468 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7469 @end deffn
7470
7471 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7472 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7473 @end deffn
7474
7475 @end deffn
7476
7477 @section NAND Flash Commands
7478 @cindex NAND
7479
7480 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7481 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7482 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7483
7484 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7485 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7486 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7487 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7488 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7489 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7490
7491 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7492 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7493 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7494 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7495 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7496 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7497 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7498 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7499 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7500 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7501
7502 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7503 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7504 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7505 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7506 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7507 every 512 bytes of data.
7508
7509 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7510 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7511 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7512 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7513 ECC mode is used.
7514
7515 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7516 @enumerate
7517 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7518 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7519 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7520 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7521 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7522 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7523 to access that device.
7524 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7525 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7526 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7527 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7528 de-brick a board.
7529 @end enumerate
7530
7531 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7532 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7533 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7534 are only 32 bits wide.
7535 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7536 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7537 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7538 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7539
7540 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7541 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7542 @cindex NAND configuration
7543
7544 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7545 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7546 OpenOCD has initialized.
7547
7548 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7549 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7550 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7551 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7552 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7553 they were a single (larger) device.
7554 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7555 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7556
7557 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7558 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7559 configuration files, not interactively.
7560
7561 @itemize @bullet
7562 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7563 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7564 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7565 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7566 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7567 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7568 commands to the NAND controller.
7569 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7570 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7571 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7572 for more information.
7573 @end itemize
7574 @end deffn
7575
7576 @deffn Command {nand list}
7577 Prints a summary of each device declared
7578 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7579 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7580 @example
7581 > nand list
7582 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7583 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7584 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7585 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7586 >
7587 @end example
7588 @end deffn
7589
7590 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7591 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7592 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7593 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7594 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7595 it with most other NAND commands.
7596 @end deffn
7597
7598 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7599
7600 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7601 @cindex NAND reading
7602 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7603 starting at the specified offset.
7604 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7605
7606 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7607 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7608
7609 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7610 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7611 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7612
7613 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7614 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7615 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7616 method which handled that error correction.
7617
7618 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7619 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7620 @itemize @bullet
7621 @item no oob_* parameter
7622 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7623 @item @code{oob_raw}
7624 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7625 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7626 spare areas associated with each data page.
7627 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7628 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7629 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7630 @item @code{oob_only}
7631 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7632 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7633 spare areas associated with each data page.
7634 @end itemize
7635 @end deffn
7636
7637 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7638 @cindex NAND erasing
7639 @cindex NAND programming
7640 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7641 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7642 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7643 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7644 If those parameters are not specified,
7645 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7646 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7647
7648 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7649 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7650 block marker.
7651 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7652 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7653 @end deffn
7654
7655 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7656 @cindex NAND writing
7657 @cindex NAND programming
7658 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7659 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7660 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7661 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7662
7663 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7664 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7665
7666 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7667 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7668 past the end of the device.
7669 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7670 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7671 if that's being written.)
7672
7673 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7674 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7675 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7676
7677 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7678 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7679 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7680 @itemize @bullet
7681 @item no oob_* parameter
7682 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7683 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7684 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7685 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7686 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7687 @item @code{oob_only}
7688 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7689 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7690 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7691 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7692 @item @code{oob_raw}
7693 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7694 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7695 un-altered OOB.
7696 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7697 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7698 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7699 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7700 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7701 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7702 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7703 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7704 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7705 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7706 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7707 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7708 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7709 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7710 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7711 @end itemize
7712 @end deffn
7713
7714 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7715 @cindex NAND verification
7716 @cindex NAND programming
7717 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7718 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7719 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7720
7721 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7722 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7723
7724 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7725 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7726 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7727 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7728 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7729
7730 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7731 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7732 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7733
7734 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7735 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7736 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7737 be removed in a future release.
7738 @end deffn
7739
7740 @subsection Other NAND commands
7741 @cindex NAND other commands
7742
7743 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7744 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7745 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7746 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7747 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7748 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7749 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7750 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7751
7752 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7753 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7754 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7755 @end deffn
7756
7757 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7758 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7759 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7760 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7761 status for each block.
7762 @end deffn
7763
7764 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7765 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7766 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7767
7768 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7769 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7770 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7771 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7772 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7773
7774 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7775 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7776 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7777 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7778 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7779 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7780 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7781 @end deffn
7782
7783 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7784 @subsection NAND Driver List
7785 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7786 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7787 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7788
7789 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7790 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7791 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7792 address of the ECC controller.
7793 @example
7794 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7795 @end example
7796 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7797 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7798 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7799 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7800 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7801 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7802 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7803 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7804 @end deffn
7805 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7806 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7807 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7808 @end deffn
7809
7810 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7811 properly configured for input or output.
7812 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7813 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7814 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7815 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7816 @end deffn
7817 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7818 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7819 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7820 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7821 @end deffn
7822 @end deffn
7823
7824 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7825 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7826 chips from Texas Instruments.
7827 It takes three extra parameters:
7828 address of the NAND chip;
7829 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7830 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7831 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7832 @example
7833 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7834 @end example
7835 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7836 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7837 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7838 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7839 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7840 @end deffn
7841
7842 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7843 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7844 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7845 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7846 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7847 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7848 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7849 @end deffn
7850
7851 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7852 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7853 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7854 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7855 @end deffn
7856 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7857
7858 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7859 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7860 should work for this chip as well.
7861 @end deffn
7862
7863 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7864 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7865 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7866 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7867 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7868 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7869 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7870 @example
7871 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7872 @end example
7873 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7874 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7875 without parameter query status.
7876 @end deffn
7877 @end deffn
7878
7879 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7880 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7881 parameter: the address of the controller.
7882 @example
7883 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7884 @end example
7885 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7886 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7887 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7888 change any behavior.
7889 @end deffn
7890
7891 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7892 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7893 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7894 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7895 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7896 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7897 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7898 specialized commands.
7899 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7900 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7901 change any behavior.
7902 @end deffn
7903
7904 @node Flash Programming
7905 @chapter Flash Programming
7906
7907 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7908 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7909 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7910
7911 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7912 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7913
7914 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7915 @enumerate
7916 @item 'init' is executed.
7917 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7918 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7919 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7920 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7921 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7922 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7923 @end enumerate
7924
7925 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7926
7927 @example
7928 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7929 # are optional parameters
7930 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7931 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7932
7933 # binary files need the flash address passing
7934 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7935 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7936 @end example
7937
7938 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7939 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7940 @cindex PLD
7941 @cindex FPGA
7942
7943 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7944 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7945 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7946 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7947 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7948 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7949 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7950
7951 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7952
7953 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7954 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7955 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7956
7957 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7958 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7959
7960 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7961 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7962 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7963 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7964 behavior.
7965 @end deffn
7966
7967 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7968 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7969 @end deffn
7970
7971 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7972 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7973 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7974 @end deffn
7975
7976 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7977
7978 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7979 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7980 that particular type of PLD.
7981
7982 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7983 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7984 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7985
7986 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7987 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7988 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7989
7990 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7991 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7992 for FPGA @var{num}.
7993 @end deffn
7994 @end deffn
7995
7996 @node General Commands
7997 @chapter General Commands
7998 @cindex commands
7999
8000 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8001 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8002 commands are documented elsewhere.
8003
8004 Intent:
8005 @itemize @bullet
8006 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8007 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8008 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8009 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8010
8011 @item @b{From the human}
8012 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8013 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8014
8015 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8016 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8017 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8018
8019 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8020 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8021 port is 5555.
8022 @end itemize
8023
8024
8025 @section Server Commands
8026
8027 @deffn {Command} exit
8028 Exits the current telnet session.
8029 @end deffn
8030
8031 @deffn {Command} help [string]
8032 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8033 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8034 Not every command provides helptext.
8035
8036 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8037 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8038 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8039 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8040 @end deffn
8041
8042 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
8043 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8044 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8045 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8046 Useful in connection with script files
8047 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8048 @end deffn
8049
8050 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
8051 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8052 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8053 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8054
8055 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8056 @example
8057 # redefine shutdown
8058 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8059 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8060 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8061 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8062 original_shutdown
8063 @}
8064 @end example
8065 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8066 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8067 @end deffn
8068
8069 @anchor{debuglevel}
8070 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
8071 @cindex message level
8072 Display debug level.
8073 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8074 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8075 Level 0 is error messages only;
8076 level 1 adds warnings;
8077 level 2 adds informational messages;
8078 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8079 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8080 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8081 the command line along with the location of that log
8082 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8083 @xref{Running}.
8084 @end deffn
8085
8086 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
8087 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8088 Output @var{message} to stdout.
8089 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8090 @example
8091 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8092 @end example
8093 @end deffn
8094
8095 @deffn Command log_output [filename | "default"]
8096 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8097 the default log output channel is stderr.
8098 @end deffn
8099
8100 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
8101 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8102 @end deffn
8103
8104 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
8105 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8106 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8107 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8108 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8109 @end deffn
8110
8111 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8112 @section Target State handling
8113 @cindex reset
8114 @cindex halt
8115 @cindex target initialization
8116
8117 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8118 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8119 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8120 a current target which is used to perform the
8121 various operations. The current target may be changed
8122 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8123 target which should become current.
8124
8125 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8126 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8127 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8128 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8129 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8130
8131 @emph{With no arguments}:
8132 list all available registers for the current target,
8133 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8134 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8135 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8136 are flagged as such.
8137
8138 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8139 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8140 bypassing any internal cache.
8141
8142 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8143 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8144 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8145 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8146 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8147 relevant module will flush such values.
8148
8149 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8150 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8151
8152 @example
8153 > reg
8154 ===== ARM registers
8155 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8156 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8157 (2) r2 (/32)
8158 ...
8159 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8160 >
8161 @end example
8162 @end deffn
8163
8164 @deffn Command halt [ms]
8165 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
8166 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8167 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8168 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8169 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8170 (and enter debug mode).
8171 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8172
8173 @quotation Warning
8174 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8175 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8176 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8177 power mode by gating the core clock;
8178 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8179
8180 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8181 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8182 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8183 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8184 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8185 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8186
8187 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8188 work with a JTAG debugger.
8189 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8190 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8191 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8192 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8193 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8194 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8195 @end quotation
8196
8197 @end deffn
8198
8199 @deffn Command resume [address]
8200 Resume the target at its current code position,
8201 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8202 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8203 @end deffn
8204
8205 @deffn Command step [address]
8206 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8207 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8208 @end deffn
8209
8210 @anchor{resetcommand}
8211 @deffn Command reset
8212 @deffnx Command {reset run}
8213 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
8214 @deffnx Command {reset init}
8215 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8216 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8217 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8218
8219 The optional parameter specifies what should
8220 happen after the reset.
8221 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8222 The other options will not work on all systems.
8223 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8224
8225 @itemize @minus
8226 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8227 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8228 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8229 @end itemize
8230 @end deffn
8231
8232 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
8233 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8234 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8235 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8236 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8237 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8238 state.
8239 @end deffn
8240
8241 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8242 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8243 Set values of reset signals.
8244 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8245 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8246 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8247 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8248
8249 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8250 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8251 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8252 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8253 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8254 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8255 the signal will not be modified.
8256
8257 @quotation Note
8258 TRST is specially handled.
8259 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8260 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8261 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8262 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8263 instead of the TRST signal.
8264 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8265 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8266 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8267 with handlers for that event.
8268 @end quotation
8269 @end deffn
8270
8271 @section I/O Utilities
8272
8273 These commands are available when
8274 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
8275 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
8276 notably the ZY1000.
8277 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
8278
8279 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
8280
8281 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
8282 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
8283 the text file @file{filename}.
8284 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
8285 The last string is followed by a newline.
8286 @end deffn
8287
8288 @deffn Command cat filename
8289 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
8290 @end deffn
8291
8292 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
8293 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
8294 into @file{dest_filename}.
8295 @end deffn
8296
8297 @deffn Command ip
8298 @emph{No description provided.}
8299 @end deffn
8300
8301 @deffn Command ls
8302 @emph{No description provided.}
8303 @end deffn
8304
8305 @deffn Command mac
8306 @emph{No description provided.}
8307 @end deffn
8308
8309 @deffn Command meminfo
8310 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
8311 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
8312 @end deffn
8313
8314 @deffn Command peek
8315 @emph{No description provided.}
8316 @end deffn
8317
8318 @deffn Command poke
8319 @emph{No description provided.}
8320 @end deffn
8321
8322 @deffn Command rm filename
8323 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
8324 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
8325 @end deffn
8326
8327 @deffn Command trunc filename
8328 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
8329 @end deffn
8330
8331 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8332 @section Memory access commands
8333 @cindex memory access
8334
8335 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8336 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8337 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8338 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8339
8340 @enumerate
8341 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8342 to change the current target.
8343 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8344 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8345 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8346 @end enumerate
8347
8348 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8349 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8350 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8351 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8352 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8353 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8354 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8355 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8356 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8357 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8358 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8359 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8360 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8361 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8362 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8363 @end deffn
8364
8365 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8366 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8367 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8368 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8369 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8370 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8371 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8372 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8373 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8374 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8375 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8376 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8377 @end deffn
8378
8379 @anchor{imageaccess}
8380 @section Image loading commands
8381 @cindex image loading
8382 @cindex image dumping
8383
8384 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8385 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8386 binary file named @var{filename}.
8387 @end deffn
8388
8389 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8390 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8391 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8392 @end deffn
8393
8394 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8395 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8396 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8397 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8398 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8399 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8400 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8401 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8402 separately.
8403 @end deffn
8404
8405 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8406 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8407 The file format may optionally be specified
8408 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8409 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8410 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8411 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8412 @example
8413 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8414 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8415 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8416 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8417 $address $length
8418 @}
8419 @end example
8420 @end deffn
8421
8422 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8423 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8424 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8425 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8426 The file format may optionally be specified
8427 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8428 @end deffn
8429
8430 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8431 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8432 The file format may optionally be specified
8433 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8434 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8435 @end deffn
8436
8437 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8438 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8439 The file format may optionally be specified
8440 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8441 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8442 @end deffn
8443
8444
8445 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8446 @cindex breakpoint
8447 @cindex watchpoint
8448
8449 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8450 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8451 watchpoints.
8452 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8453
8454 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8455 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8456 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8457 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8458 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8459 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8460
8461 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8462 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8463 @end deffn
8464
8465 @deffn Command {rbp} @option{all} | address
8466 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8467 @end deffn
8468
8469 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8470 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8471 @end deffn
8472
8473 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8474 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8475 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8476 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8477 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8478 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8479 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8480 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8481 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8482 @end deffn
8483
8484
8485 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8486
8487 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8488 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8489 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8490 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8491 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8492 running, can be used.
8493 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8494 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8495 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8496
8497 @quotation Note
8498 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8499 @end quotation
8500
8501 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8502 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8503 communication, respectively.
8504
8505 @quotation Note
8506 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8507 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8508 example.
8509 @end quotation
8510
8511 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8512 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8513 of TCP/IP connections.
8514
8515 @deffn Command {rtt setup} address size ID
8516 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8517 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8518 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8519 @var{size} bytes.
8520 @end deffn
8521
8522 @deffn Command {rtt start}
8523 Start RTT.
8524 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8525 @end deffn
8526
8527 @deffn Command {rtt stop}
8528 Stop RTT.
8529 @end deffn
8530
8531 @deffn Command {rtt polling_interval [interval]}
8532 Display the polling interval.
8533 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8534 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8535 checked for new data.
8536 @end deffn
8537
8538 @deffn Command {rtt channels}
8539 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8540 @end deffn
8541
8542 @deffn Command {rtt channellist}
8543 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8544 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8545 @end deffn
8546
8547 @deffn Command {rtt server start} port channel
8548 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8549 @end deffn
8550
8551 @deffn Command {rtt server stop} port
8552 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8553 @end deffn
8554
8555 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8556 on the target device.
8557
8558 @example
8559 resume
8560
8561 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8562 rtt start
8563
8564 rtt server start 9090 0
8565 @end example
8566
8567 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8568 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8569 TCP/IP port 9090.
8570
8571
8572 @section Misc Commands
8573
8574 @cindex profiling
8575 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8576 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8577 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8578 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8579 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8580 limit the address range.
8581 @end deffn
8582
8583 @deffn Command {version}
8584 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8585 @end deffn
8586
8587 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8588 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8589 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8590 @end deffn
8591
8592 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8593 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8594 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8595 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8596
8597 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8598 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8599 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8600 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8601
8602 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8603 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8604 @cindex tracing
8605 @cindex ETM
8606 @cindex ETB
8607
8608 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8609 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8610 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8611
8612 @itemize
8613 @item
8614 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8615 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8616 supports such an interface.
8617 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8618 and trace port support.)
8619 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8620 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8621 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8622 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8623 in the board-specific configuration file.
8624 @item
8625 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8626 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8627 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8628 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8629 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8630 @end itemize
8631
8632 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8633
8634 @quotation Issues
8635 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8636 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8637
8638 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8639 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8640 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8641 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8642 dummy trace port driver}.
8643
8644 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8645 as well as tracing only during specific states
8646 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8647
8648 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8649 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8650 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8651 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8652 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8653
8654 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8655 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8656 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8657 this original style of JTAG access.
8658 @end quotation
8659
8660 @subsection ETM Configuration
8661 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8662
8663 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8664 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8665 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8666
8667 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8668 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8669 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8670 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8671 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8672 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8673 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8674 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8675 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8676
8677 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8678 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8679 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8680
8681 @quotation Warning
8682 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8683 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8684 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8685 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8686 @end quotation
8687
8688 @quotation Note
8689 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8690 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8691 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8692 what CPU activities are traced.
8693 @end quotation
8694 @end deffn
8695
8696 @deffn Command {etm info}
8697 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8698 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8699 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8700 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8701 @end deffn
8702
8703 @deffn Command {etm status}
8704 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8705 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8706 Did trace data overflow?
8707 Was it triggered?
8708 @end deffn
8709
8710 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8711 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8712 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8713 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8714 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8715
8716 @itemize
8717 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8718 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8719 The value is one of
8720 @option{none} (save nothing),
8721 @option{data} (save data),
8722 @option{address} (save addresses),
8723 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8724 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8725 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8726 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8727 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8728 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8729 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8730 trace stream without an image of the code.
8731 @end itemize
8732 @end deffn
8733
8734 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8735 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8736 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8737 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8738 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8739
8740 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8741 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8742 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8743 @end deffn
8744
8745 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8746
8747 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8748 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8749 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8750
8751 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8752 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8753 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8754 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8755 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8756 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8757 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8758
8759 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8760
8761 @itemize
8762 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8763 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8764 for instruction access within that function's body.
8765 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8766 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8767 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8768 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8769 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8770 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8771 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8772 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8773 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8774 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8775 @item @emph{... more}
8776 @end itemize
8777
8778 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8779 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8780
8781 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8782 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8783 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8784 @end deffn
8785
8786 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8787 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8788 @end deffn
8789
8790 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8791 Opens an image file.
8792 @end deffn
8793
8794 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8795 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8796 @end deffn
8797
8798 @deffn Command {etm start}
8799 Starts trace data collection.
8800 @end deffn
8801
8802 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8803 Stops trace data collection.
8804 @end deffn
8805
8806 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8807 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8808
8809 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8810
8811 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8812 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8813 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8814 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8815 any trace data collection.}
8816 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8817 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8818 @end deffn
8819 @end deffn
8820
8821 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8822 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8823 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8824 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8825 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8826 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8827 @end deffn
8828 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8829 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8830 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8831 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8832 trace trigger becomes active.
8833
8834 @itemize
8835 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8836 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8837 afterwards.
8838 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8839 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8840 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8841 what caused that event to happen.
8842 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8843 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8844 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8845 how the event caused trouble.
8846 @end itemize
8847 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8848 @end deffn
8849
8850 @end deffn
8851
8852 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8853 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8854 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8855 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8856 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8857
8858 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8859 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8860
8861 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8862 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8863 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8864 @end deffn
8865
8866 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8867 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8868 @end deffn
8869
8870 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8871 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8872 @end deffn
8873 @end deffn
8874
8875 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8876 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8877 @cindex CTI
8878
8879 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8880 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8881 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8882 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8883 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8884 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8885
8886 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8887 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8888 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8889 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8890 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8891 including additional configuration.
8892 @end deffn
8893
8894 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8895 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8896 @end deffn
8897
8898 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8899 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8900 @end deffn
8901
8902 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8903 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8904 @end deffn
8905
8906 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8907 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8908 @end deffn
8909
8910 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8911 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8912 @end deffn
8913
8914 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8915 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8916 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8917 @end deffn
8918
8919 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8920 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8921 of the CTI.
8922 @end deffn
8923
8924 @deffn Command {cti names}
8925 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8926 useful in TCL scripting.
8927 @end deffn
8928
8929 @section Generic ARM
8930 @cindex ARM
8931
8932 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8933 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8934 commands that may be available.
8935
8936 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8937 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8938 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8939 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8940 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8941 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8942 @end deffn
8943
8944 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8945 @cindex disassemble
8946 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8947 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8948 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8949 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8950 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8951 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8952 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8953
8954 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8955 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8956 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8957 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8958 with a handful of exceptions.
8959 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8960 @end deffn
8961
8962 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8963 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8964 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8965 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8966 and using the MCR instruction.
8967 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8968 an ARM register.)
8969 @end deffn
8970
8971 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8972 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8973 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8974 and the MRC instruction.
8975 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8976 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8977 an ARM register.)
8978 @end deffn
8979
8980 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8981 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8982 core mode if necessary.
8983 @end deffn
8984
8985 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8986 @cindex ARM semihosting
8987 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8988
8989 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8990 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8991 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8992 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8993 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8994 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8995 @end deffn
8996
8997 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8998 @cindex ARM semihosting
8999 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9000
9001 @example
9002 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9003 @end example
9004
9005 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9006 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9007 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9008 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9009 @end deffn
9010
9011 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9012 @cindex ARM semihosting
9013 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9014 status.
9015
9016 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9017 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9018 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9019 debugger.
9020 @end deffn
9021
9022 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9023 @cindex ARM semihosting
9024 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9025
9026 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9027 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9028 the value returned by the target.
9029
9030 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9031 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9032 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9033 encountering a break.
9034
9035 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9036 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9037 to the debugger.
9038 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9039 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9040 request or equivalent").
9041
9042 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9043 this option (default: disabled).
9044 @end deffn
9045
9046 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9047 @cindex ARMv4
9048 @cindex ARMv5
9049
9050 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9051 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9052 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9053 variant.
9054
9055 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9056 @cindex ARM7
9057 @cindex ARM9
9058
9059 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9060 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9061 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9062 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9063
9064 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9065 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9066 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9067 instead of breakpoints.
9068 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9069
9070 This should be
9071 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9072 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9073 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9074 @end deffn
9075
9076 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9077 @cindex DCC
9078 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9079 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9080 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9081
9082 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9083 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9084 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9085 @end deffn
9086
9087 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9088 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9089 that don't check completion of the operation.
9090 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9091
9092 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9093 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9094 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9095 @end deffn
9096
9097 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
9098 @cindex ARM720T
9099
9100 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
9101 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9102 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
9103 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
9104
9105 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
9106 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
9107 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
9108
9109 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
9110 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9111 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
9112 @end deffn
9113
9114 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9115 @cindex ARM9
9116
9117 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9118 integer processors.
9119 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9120
9121 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9122 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9123 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9124 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9125
9126 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9127 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9128 @cindex vector_catch
9129 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9130 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9131 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9132 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9133 to those hardware vectors.
9134
9135 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9136 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9137 vector catch hardware to intercept
9138 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9139 @option{none} of them,
9140 or a list with one or more of the following:
9141 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9142 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9143 @end deffn
9144
9145 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9146 @cindex ARM920T
9147
9148 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9149 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9150 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9151 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9152 and ARM9 commands.
9153
9154 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
9155 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9156 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9157 @end deffn
9158
9159 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9160 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9161 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9162 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9163 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9164 (Not all registers can be written.)
9165 @end deffn
9166
9167 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
9168 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
9169 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
9170
9171 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
9172 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
9173 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
9174 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
9175 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
9176 or using zero if no other address is provided.
9177 @end deffn
9178
9179 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
9180 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9181 @end deffn
9182
9183 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9184 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9185 @end deffn
9186
9187 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9188 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9189
9190 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9191 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9192 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9193 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9194 and ARM9 commands.
9195
9196 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9197 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9198
9199 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
9200 Print information about the caches found.
9201 @end deffn
9202
9203 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9204 @cindex ARM966E
9205
9206 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9207 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9208 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9209 and ARM9 commands.
9210
9211 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9212 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9213 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9214 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9215 ARM966E-S TRM.
9216 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9217 as required for BIST support.
9218 @end deffn
9219
9220 @subsection XScale specific commands
9221 @cindex XScale
9222
9223 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9224
9225 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9226 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9227 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9228 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9229 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9230 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9231 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9232
9233 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9234 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9235 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9236 the mini-IC.
9237
9238 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9239 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9240 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9241 code layout in memory:
9242 @example
9243 _vectors:
9244 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9245 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9246 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9247 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9248 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9249 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9250 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9251 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9252 .org 0x100
9253 .long real_reset_vector
9254 .long real_ui_handler
9255 .long real_swi_handler
9256 .long real_pf_abort
9257 .long real_data_abort
9258 .long 0 /* unused */
9259 .long real_irq_handler
9260 .long real_fiq_handler
9261 @end example
9262
9263 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9264 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9265 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9266 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9267 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9268 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9269 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9270 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9271 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9272 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9273 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9274 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9275 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9276 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9277 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9278 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9279 software.
9280
9281 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9282 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9283 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9284 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9285
9286 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9287 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9288 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9289 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9290 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9291 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9292 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9293 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9294 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9295
9296 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9297 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9298
9299 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
9300 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9301 @end deffn
9302
9303 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9304 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9305 @end deffn
9306
9307 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
9308 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9309 @end deffn
9310
9311 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9312 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9313 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9314 @end deffn
9315
9316 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
9317 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9318 @end deffn
9319
9320 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9321 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9322 @end deffn
9323
9324 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
9325 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9326 @end deffn
9327
9328 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9329 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9330 @end deffn
9331
9332 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9333 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9334 @end deffn
9335
9336 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9337 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9338 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9339 and modifying how it is emptied.
9340 @end deffn
9341
9342 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9343 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9344 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9345 The image @var{type} may be one of
9346 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9347 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9348 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9349 @end deffn
9350
9351 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9352 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9353 @cindex vector_catch
9354 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9355 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9356
9357 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9358 @example
9359 0x01 Trap Reset
9360 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9361 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9362 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9363 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9364 0x20 reserved
9365 0x40 Trap IRQ
9366 0x80 Trap FIQ
9367 @end example
9368 @end deffn
9369
9370 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9371 @cindex vector_table
9372
9373 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9374 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9375 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9376 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9377 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9378
9379 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9380
9381 @end deffn
9382
9383 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9384 @cindex ARMv6
9385
9386 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9387 @cindex ARM11
9388
9389 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9390 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9391 which is enabled by default.
9392 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9393 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9394 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9395 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9396 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9397 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9398 @end deffn
9399
9400 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9401 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9402 which is enabled by default.
9403 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9404 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9405 @end deffn
9406
9407 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9408 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9409 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9410 they are disabled by default.
9411 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9412 @end deffn
9413
9414 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9415 @cindex vector_catch
9416 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9417 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9418 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9419
9420 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9421 for certain hardware events.
9422 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9423 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9424 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9425 @end deffn
9426
9427 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9428 @cindex ARMv7
9429 @cindex ARMv8
9430
9431 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9432 @cindex Cortex-A
9433
9434 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9435 display information about target caches
9436 @end deffn
9437
9438 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9439 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9440 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9441 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9442 Defaults to 'off'.
9443 @end deffn
9444
9445 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9446 Initialize core debug
9447 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9448 @end deffn
9449
9450 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9451 Display/set the current SMP mode
9452 @end deffn
9453
9454 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9455 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9456 @end deffn
9457
9458 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9459 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9460 @end deffn
9461
9462 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9463 configure l2x cache
9464 @end deffn
9465
9466 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9467 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9468 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9469 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9470 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9471 @end deffn
9472
9473 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9474 @cindex Cortex-R
9475
9476 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9477 Initialize core debug
9478 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9479 @end deffn
9480
9481 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9482 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9483 @end deffn
9484
9485
9486 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9487 @cindex tracing
9488 @cindex SWO
9489 @cindex SWV
9490 @cindex TPIU
9491 @cindex ITM
9492 @cindex ETM
9493
9494 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | @var{:port} | -)}) @
9495 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
9496 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
9497
9498 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
9499 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9500 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9501 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9502
9503 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9504 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9505 debugger adapter features.
9506
9507 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9508 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9509
9510 Command options:
9511 @itemize @minus
9512 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9513 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9514 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware).
9515 @item @option{internal (@var{filename} | @var{:port} | -)} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9516 gather trace data then:
9517
9518 @itemize @minus
9519 @item append it to a regular file or a named pipe if @var{filename} is specified.
9520 @item listen to a TCP/IP port if @var{:port} is specified, then broadcast the trace data over this port.
9521 @item if '-' is specified, OpenOCD will forward trace data to @command{tcl_trace} command.
9522 @*@b{Note:} while broadcasting to file or TCP, the forwarding to @command{tcl_trace} will remain active.
9523 @end itemize
9524
9525 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9526 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width}.
9527 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9528 coding.
9529 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9530 regular UART 8N1) coding.
9531 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9532 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9533 data is to be output via SWO.
9534 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9535 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK).
9536 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9537 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9538 rate automatically.
9539 @end itemize
9540
9541 Example usage:
9542 @enumerate
9543 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9544 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9545 enough to:
9546 @example
9547 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9548 ...
9549 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9550 ...
9551 @end example
9552 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9553 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9554 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9555 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9556 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9557 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9558 @example
9559 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9560 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9561 @end example
9562 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9563 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9564 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9565 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9566 @example
9567 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9568 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9569 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9570 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9571 @end example
9572 @end enumerate
9573 @end deffn
9574
9575 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9576 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9577 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9578 @end deffn
9579
9580 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9581 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9582 @end deffn
9583
9584 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9585 @cindex Cortex-M
9586
9587 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9588 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9589
9590 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9591 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9592 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9593 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9594 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9595 the step command leaves with the core running.
9596
9597 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9598 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9599 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9600 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9601
9602 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9603 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9604 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9605 does.
9606
9607 Default is @option{auto}.
9608 @end deffn
9609
9610 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9611 @cindex vector_catch
9612 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9613 for certain hardware events.
9614
9615 Parameters request interception of
9616 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9617 @option{none} of them,
9618 or one or more of the following:
9619 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9620 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9621 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9622 @option{irq_err},
9623 @option{state_err},
9624 @option{chk_err}, or
9625 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9626 @option{reset}.
9627 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9628 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9629 are mapped to HardFault.
9630 UsageFault checks for
9631 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9632 must also be explicitly enabled.
9633
9634 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9635 @end deffn
9636
9637 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9638 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9639 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9640
9641 @itemize @minus
9642 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9643 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9644 @end itemize
9645
9646 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9647 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9648 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9649 to manually reset the peripherals.
9650 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9651
9652 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9653 instead.
9654 @end deffn
9655
9656 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9657 @cindex ARMv8-A
9658 @cindex aarch64
9659
9660 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9661 Display information about target caches
9662 @end deffn
9663
9664 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9665 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9666 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9667 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9668 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9669 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9670 @end deffn
9671
9672 @deffn Command {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9673 @cindex disassemble
9674 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9675 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9676 @end deffn
9677
9678 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9679 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9680 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9681 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9682 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9683 @end deffn
9684
9685 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9686 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9687 @option{on}.
9688 @end deffn
9689
9690 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9691 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9692 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9693 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9694 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9695 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9696 @end deffn
9697
9698 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9699
9700 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9701 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9702
9703 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9704
9705 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9706 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9707 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9708 @end deffn
9709
9710 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9711 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9712 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9713 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9714 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9715 @end deffn
9716
9717 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9718
9719 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9720 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9721 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9722 @end deffn
9723
9724 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9725
9726 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9727 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9728 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9729 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9730 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9731 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9732 can be collected.
9733
9734 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9735 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9736 tooling.
9737
9738 @quotation Issues
9739 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9740 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9741 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9742 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9743
9744 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9745 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9746 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9747 software operation on the CPU.
9748 @end quotation
9749
9750 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9751 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9752 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9753 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9754 @end deffn
9755
9756 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9757 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9758 @end deffn
9759
9760 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9761 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9762 control is disabled.
9763 @end deffn
9764
9765 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9766 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9767 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9768 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9769
9770 Supported trace formats:
9771 @itemize
9772 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9773 timing to be determined.
9774 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9775 addresses.
9776 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9777 @end itemize
9778 @end deffn
9779
9780 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9781 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9782 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9783 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9784
9785 Supported conditions:
9786 @itemize
9787 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9788 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9789 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9790 instruction matches start data and mask.
9791 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9792 instruction matches start data and mask.
9793 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9794 data and mask.
9795 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9796 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9797 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9798 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9799 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9800 @end itemize
9801 @end deffn
9802
9803 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9804 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9805 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9806 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9807
9808 Supported conditions:
9809 @itemize
9810 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9811 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9812 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9813 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9814 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9815 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9816 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9817 data and mask.
9818 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9819 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9820 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9821 @end itemize
9822 @end deffn
9823
9824 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9825 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9826
9827 Supported triggers:
9828 @itemize
9829 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9830 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9831 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9832 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9833 collection.
9834 @end itemize
9835 @end deffn
9836
9837 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9838
9839 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9840 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9841 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9842 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9843 @end deffn
9844
9845 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9846 Display trace configuration.
9847 @end deffn
9848
9849 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9850 Display trace collection status.
9851 @end deffn
9852
9853 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9854 Start manual trace collection.
9855 @end deffn
9856
9857 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9858 Stop manual trace collection.
9859 @end deffn
9860
9861 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9862 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9863 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9864 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9865 @option{size} options using DMA.
9866 @end deffn
9867
9868 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9869 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9870 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9871 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9872 @option{size} options using DMA.
9873 @end deffn
9874
9875 @section Intel Architecture
9876
9877 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9878 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9879 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9880 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9881 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9882 @itemize
9883 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9884 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9885 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9886 @end itemize
9887
9888 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9889 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9890 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9891
9892 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9893 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9894 @end deffn
9895
9896 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9897 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9898 @end deffn
9899
9900 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9901 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9902 @end deffn
9903
9904 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9905 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9906 @end deffn
9907
9908 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9909 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9910 @end deffn
9911
9912 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9913 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9914 @end deffn
9915
9916 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9917
9918 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9919 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9920
9921 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9922 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9923 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9924 @end deffn
9925 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9926 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9927
9928 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9929
9930 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9931 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9932 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9933 @end deffn
9934
9935 @subsection Registers commands
9936 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9937 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9938 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9939
9940 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9941
9942 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9943 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9944 and "timer" groups.
9945
9946 @emph{example:}
9947 @example
9948 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9949 @end example
9950
9951
9952 @end deffn
9953 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9954 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9955
9956 @emph{group} can be "system",
9957 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9958 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9959 @end deffn
9960
9961 @section RISC-V Architecture
9962
9963 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9964 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9965 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9966 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9967 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9968 implement version 0.11.
9969
9970 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9971
9972 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9973 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9974 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9975
9976 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9977
9978 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9979 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9980 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9981
9982 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9983 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9984 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9985 CSRs.
9986 @end deffn
9987
9988 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9989 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9990 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9991 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9992 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9993 This command must be executed before `init`.
9994 @end deffn
9995
9996 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9997 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9998 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9999 @end deffn
10000
10001 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10002 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10003 deasserted.
10004 @end deffn
10005
10006 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
10007 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
10008 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
10009 @end deffn
10010
10011 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10012 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10013 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10014 @end deffn
10015
10016 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10017 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10018 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10019 on physical memory.
10020 @end deffn
10021
10022 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10023 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10024 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10025 performed on physical memory.
10026 @end deffn
10027
10028 @deffn Command {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10029 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10030 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10031 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10032 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10033 race condition problem in your code.
10034
10035 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10036 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10037 @end deffn
10038
10039 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10040 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10041 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10042 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10043 values.
10044
10045 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10046 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10047 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10048 @end deffn
10049
10050 @deffn Command {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10051 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10052 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10053 @end deffn
10054
10055 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10056 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10057 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10058 @end deffn
10059
10060 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10061 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10062 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10063 @end deffn
10064
10065 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10066 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10067 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10068 @end deffn
10069
10070 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10071
10072 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10073 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10074 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10075 @example
10076 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10077 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10078 @end example
10079
10080 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
10081 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10082 @end deffn
10083
10084 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
10085 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10086 @end deffn
10087
10088 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10089
10090 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10091 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10092
10093 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read} address
10094 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10095 @end deffn
10096
10097 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
10098 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10099 @end deffn
10100
10101 @section ARC Architecture
10102 @cindex ARC
10103
10104 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10105 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10106 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10107 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10108 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10109 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10110 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10111 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10112 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10113 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10114 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10115 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10116 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10117 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10118 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10119
10120
10121 @subsection General ARC commands
10122
10123 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10124
10125 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10126 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10127 arguments:
10128
10129 @itemize @bullet
10130
10131 @item @code{-name} name
10132 @*Name of a register.
10133
10134 @item @code{-num} number
10135 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10136
10137 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10138 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10139
10140 @end itemize
10141
10142 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10143
10144 @itemize @bullet
10145
10146 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10147 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10148 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10149 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10150 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10151 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10152
10153 @item @code{-core}
10154 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10155 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10156 spaces.
10157
10158 @item @code{-bcr}
10159 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10160 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10161 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10162 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10163 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10164
10165 @item @code{-type} type_name
10166 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10167 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10168
10169 @item @code{-g}
10170 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10171 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10172 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10173 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10174 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10175
10176 @end itemize
10177
10178 @end deffn
10179
10180 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10181 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10182 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10183 @end deffn
10184
10185 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10186 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10187 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10188 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10189 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10190 startbit endbit}.
10191 @end deffn
10192
10193 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10194 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10195 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct} command definition.
10196 @end deffn
10197
10198 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10199 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10200 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10201 @end deffn
10202
10203 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10204
10205 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10206 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10207 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10208 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10209
10210 @end deffn
10211
10212 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10213 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10214 registers.
10215 @end deffn
10216
10217 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10218 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10219 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10220 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10221
10222 @end deffn
10223
10224 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10225 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10226 registers.
10227 @end deffn
10228
10229 @section STM8 Architecture
10230 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10231 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10232
10233 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10234 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10235
10236 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10237 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10238 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10239 @cindex tracing
10240 @cindex libdcc
10241 @cindex DCC
10242 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10243 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10244 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10245 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10246
10247 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10248 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10249 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10250 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10251 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10252 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10253
10254 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10255 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10256 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10257 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10258 The target being debugged may
10259 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10260 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10261 each supported by a command:
10262
10263 @itemize
10264 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10265 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10266 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10267 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10268
10269 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10270 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10271 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10272
10273 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10274 and then displayed at any time.
10275 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10276
10277 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10278 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10279 @end itemize
10280
10281 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10282 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10283 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10284 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10285 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10286 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10287 does the same thing.
10288
10289 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10290 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10291 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10292 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10293 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10294
10295 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10296 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10297 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10298 @end deffn
10299
10300 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10301 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10302 in the order they triggered.
10303 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10304 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10305 history records.
10306 @end deffn
10307
10308 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10309 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10310 they have been triggered.
10311 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10312 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10313 and associates it with that identifier.
10314
10315 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10316 are not related except by this command.
10317 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10318 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10319 @end deffn
10320
10321
10322 @node JTAG Commands
10323 @chapter JTAG Commands
10324 @cindex JTAG Commands
10325 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10326 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10327 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10328 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10329 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10330
10331 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10332 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10333
10334 @itemize @bullet
10335 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10336 devices such as a CPUs.
10337 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10338 standard state machine (in parallel)
10339 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10340 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10341 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10342 while the reading previous ones.
10343 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10344 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10345 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10346 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10347 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10348 registers.
10349 @end itemize
10350
10351 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10352
10353 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10354 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10355 the order of TAP state transitions.
10356 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10357 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10358 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10359 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10360 these commands are not available.
10361
10362 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10363 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10364 that specify the entire register.
10365 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10366 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10367 The return value holds the original value of each
10368 of those fields.
10369
10370 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10371 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10372 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10373 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10374 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10375
10376 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10377 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10378
10379 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10380 in that state.
10381 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10382 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10383 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10384
10385 @quotation Warning
10386 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10387 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10388 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10389 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10390 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10391 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10392 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10393 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10394 @end quotation
10395 @end deffn
10396
10397 @deffn Command {flush_count}
10398 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10399 This may be used for performance tuning.
10400
10401 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10402 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10403 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10404 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10405 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10406 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10407 @end deffn
10408
10409 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10410 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10411 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10412 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10413 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10414 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10415
10416 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10417 in that state.
10418 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10419 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10420 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10421
10422 @quotation Note
10423 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10424 register values, unlike data register values.
10425 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10426 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10427 @end quotation
10428 @end deffn
10429
10430 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10431 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10432 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10433 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10434 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10435 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10436 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10437 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10438 The final state must also be stable.
10439 @end deffn
10440
10441 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10442 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10443 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10444 Instructions often need some time
10445 to execute before they take effect.
10446 @end deffn
10447
10448 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10449 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10450
10451 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10452 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10453 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10454 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10455 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10456 @end deffn
10457
10458 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10459 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10460 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10461 must also be enabled.
10462 Default is enabled.
10463 @end deffn
10464
10465 @section TAP state names
10466 @cindex TAP state names
10467
10468 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10469 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10470 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10471 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10472
10473 @itemize @bullet
10474 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10475 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10476 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10477 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10478 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10479 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10480 through the data register
10481 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10482 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10483 for update or more shifting
10484 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10485 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10486 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10487 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10488 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10489 through the instruction register
10490 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10491 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10492 for update or more shifting
10493 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10494 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10495 @end itemize
10496
10497 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10498 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10499 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10500 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10501
10502 @itemize @bullet
10503 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10504 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10505 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10506 may not be as expected.
10507 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10508 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10509 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10510 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10511 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10512 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10513 @end itemize
10514
10515 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10516 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10517
10518 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10519 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10520 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10521 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10522
10523 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10524 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10525 @cindex SVF
10526
10527 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10528 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10529 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10530 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10531
10532 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10533 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10534 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10535 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10536
10537 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10538 affect their semantics.
10539
10540 Command options:
10541 @itemize @minus
10542 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10543 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10544 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10545 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10546 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10547 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10548 on the real interface;
10549 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10550 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10551 errors.
10552 @end itemize
10553 @end deffn
10554
10555 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10556 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10557 @cindex XSVF
10558
10559 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10560 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10561 Xilinx devices.
10562 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10563 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10564
10565 @quotation Important
10566 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10567 @end quotation
10568
10569 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10570 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10571 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10572 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10573 that TAP.
10574 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10575 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10576 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10577 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10578 @end deffn
10579
10580 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10581 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10582 after building the software.
10583 You may find them useful:
10584
10585 @itemize
10586 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10587 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10588 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10589 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10590 @end itemize
10591
10592 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10593 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10594 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10595 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10596 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10597 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10598 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10599
10600
10601 @node Utility Commands
10602 @chapter Utility Commands
10603 @cindex Utility Commands
10604
10605 @section RAM testing
10606 @cindex RAM testing
10607
10608 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10609 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10610 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10611 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10612 hardware problems.
10613
10614 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10615 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10616 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10617 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10618
10619 Load the memory testing functions with
10620
10621 @example
10622 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10623 @end example
10624
10625 to get access to the following facilities:
10626
10627 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10628 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10629 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10630 @end deffn
10631
10632 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10633 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10634 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10635 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10636 @end deffn
10637
10638 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10639 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10640 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10641 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10642 @end deffn
10643
10644 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10645 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10646 @end deffn
10647
10648 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10649 @cindex Firmware recovery
10650
10651 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10652 devices recovery with JTAG.
10653
10654 For quickstart instructions run:
10655 @example
10656 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10657 @end example
10658
10659 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10660 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10661 @cindex GDB
10662 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10663 to debug remote targets.
10664 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10665
10666 @itemize
10667 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10668 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10669 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10670 as shown in this chapter.
10671 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10672 that also will probably need to be configured.
10673 @end itemize
10674
10675 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10676 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10677 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10678 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10679 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10680 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10681
10682 @section Connecting to GDB
10683 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10684 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10685 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10686 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10687 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10688
10689 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10690
10691 @enumerate
10692 @item
10693 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10694 @example
10695 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10696 @end example
10697 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10698
10699 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10700 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10701 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10702
10703 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10704 remote command above that becomes:
10705 @example
10706 tar ext :3333
10707 @end example
10708
10709 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10710 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10711 available through the command:
10712 @example
10713 target remote localhost:3333
10714 @end example
10715
10716 @item
10717 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10718 @example
10719 target extended-remote | \
10720 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10721 @end example
10722 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10723 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10724 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10725 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10726 @end enumerate
10727
10728 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10729 GDB command line.
10730
10731 @section Sample GDB session startup
10732
10733 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10734 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10735 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10736 small ARM program.
10737 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10738 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10739
10740 @example
10741 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10742 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10743 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10744 ...
10745 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10746 ...
10747 (gdb) load
10748 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10749 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10750 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10751 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10752 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10753 (gdb) continue
10754 Continuing.
10755 ...
10756 @end example
10757
10758 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10759 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10760 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10761 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10762
10763 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10764
10765 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10766 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10767 packet size and the device's memory map.
10768 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10769 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10770 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10771
10772 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10773 You may need to set those up by hand.
10774 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10775 something like:
10776
10777 @example
10778 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10779 @end example
10780
10781 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10782
10783 @example
10784 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10785 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10786 @end example
10787
10788 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10789 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10790 do not have such restrictions.
10791
10792 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10793 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10794 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10795 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10796
10797 @section Programming using GDB
10798 @cindex Programming using GDB
10799 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10800
10801 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10802 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10803 @example
10804 gdb_memory_map disable
10805 @end example
10806 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10807 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10808 working area.
10809
10810 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10811 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10812 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10813 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10814
10815 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10816 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10817
10818 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10819 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10820 @example
10821 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10822 @end example
10823
10824 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10825 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10826
10827 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10828 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10829 will be used.
10830
10831 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10832 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10833 @example
10834 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10835 @end example
10836 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10837
10838 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10839 can be used.
10840
10841 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10842 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10843 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10844
10845 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10846 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10847 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10848
10849 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10850 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10851 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10852 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10853 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10854 without any intrusion of the target process.
10855
10856 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10857 Place following command after target configuration:
10858 @example
10859 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10860 @end example
10861
10862 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10863 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10864 @example
10865 gdb_memory_map disable
10866 @end example
10867
10868 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10869 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10870 @example
10871 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10872 @end example
10873
10874 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10875 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10876
10877 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
10878 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10879 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10880 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10881
10882 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10883 previously shown variables.
10884
10885 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
10886 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
10887 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
10888 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
10889 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
10890
10891 @section RTOS Support
10892 @cindex RTOS Support
10893 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10894
10895 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10896 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10897
10898 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10899 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10900 GDB commands.
10901
10902 @* An example setup is below:
10903
10904 @example
10905 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10906 @end example
10907
10908 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10909
10910 Currently supported rtos's include:
10911 @itemize @bullet
10912 @item @option{eCos}
10913 @item @option{ThreadX}
10914 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10915 @item @option{linux}
10916 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10917 @item @option{embKernel}
10918 @item @option{mqx}
10919 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10920 @item @option{nuttx}
10921 @item @option{RIOT}
10922 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10923 @end itemize
10924
10925 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10926 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10927
10928 @table @code
10929 @item eCos symbols
10930 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10931 @item ThreadX symbols
10932 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10933 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10934 @raggedright
10935 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10936 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10937 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10938 @end raggedright
10939 @item linux symbols
10940 init_task.
10941 @item ChibiOS symbols
10942 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10943 @item embKernel symbols
10944 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10945 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10946 @item mqx symbols
10947 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10948 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10949 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
10950 @item nuttx symbols
10951 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
10952 @item RIOT symbols
10953 @raggedright
10954 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
10955 _tcb_name_offset.
10956 @end raggedright
10957 @end table
10958
10959 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10960 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10961
10962 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10963 along with the project:
10964
10965 @table @code
10966 @item FreeRTOS
10967 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10968 @item uC/OS-III
10969 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10970 @end table
10971
10972 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10973 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10974 @cindex SMP
10975 @cindex RTOS
10976 @cindex hwthread
10977 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10978 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10979 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10980 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10981 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10982 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10983 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10984 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10985 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10986
10987 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10988 @quotation Note
10989 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10990 @end quotation
10991
10992 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10993 @itemize @bullet
10994 @item j - smp status request
10995 @item J - smp set request
10996 @end itemize
10997
10998 OpenOCD implements :
10999 @itemize @bullet
11000 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11001 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11002 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11003 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11004 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11005 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11006 @end itemize
11007
11008 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11009 @itemize @bullet
11010 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11011 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11012 @example
11013 set $_core 1
11014 #Jc01 packet is sent
11015 print $_core
11016 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11017 @end example
11018
11019 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11020 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11021
11022 @example
11023 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11024 define toggle0
11025 maint packet Jc0
11026 continue
11027 main packet Jc-1
11028 end
11029 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11030 define toggle1
11031 maint packet Jc1
11032 continue
11033 main packet Jc-1
11034 end
11035 @end example
11036 @end itemize
11037
11038 @node Tcl Scripting API
11039 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11040 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11041 @cindex Tcl scripts
11042 @section API rules
11043
11044 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11045 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11046 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11047
11048 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11049 pair list and lists.
11050
11051 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11052 list.
11053
11054 @example
11055 > set foo(me) Duane
11056 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11057 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11058 > set foo(duck) Donald
11059 @end example
11060
11061 If one does this:
11062
11063 @example
11064 > set foo
11065 @end example
11066
11067 The result is:
11068
11069 @example
11070 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11071 @end example
11072
11073 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11074
11075 @verbatim
11076 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11077 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11078 }
11079 @end verbatim
11080
11081 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11082 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11083
11084 @section Internal low-level Commands
11085
11086 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
11087 invoke directly.
11088
11089 @itemize @bullet
11090 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11091
11092 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11093 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11094
11095 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11096 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11097
11098 Return information about the flash banks
11099
11100 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11101
11102 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11103 its execution. Example:
11104
11105 @example
11106 > capture "reset init"
11107 @end example
11108
11109 @end itemize
11110
11111 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11112 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11113 called "flash_banks".
11114
11115 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
11116
11117 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
11118 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
11119 holds one of the following values:
11120
11121 @itemize @bullet
11122 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
11123 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
11124 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
11125 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
11126 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
11127 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
11128 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
11129 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
11130 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
11131 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
11132 @end itemize
11133
11134 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
11135
11136 @quotation Note
11137 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
11138 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
11139 @code{jim_platform} (because it
11140 is jim, not real tcl).
11141 @end quotation
11142
11143 @section Tcl RPC server
11144 @cindex RPC
11145
11146 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11147 commands and receive the results.
11148
11149 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11150 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11151 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11152 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11153 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11154
11155 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11156 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11157 @command{capture} command.
11158
11159 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11160
11161 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11162 @cindex RPC Notifications
11163
11164 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11165 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11166
11167 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11168 in the following format.
11169
11170 @verbatim
11171 type target_event event [event-name]
11172 type target_state state [state-name]
11173 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11174 @end verbatim
11175
11176 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
11177 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11178 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11179 Defaults to off.
11180
11181 @end deffn
11182
11183 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11184 @cindex RPC trace output
11185
11186 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11187 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11188
11189 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11190
11191 @verbatim
11192 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11193 @end verbatim
11194
11195 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
11196 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11197 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11198 Defaults to off.
11199
11200 See an example application here:
11201 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11202
11203 @end deffn
11204
11205 @node FAQ
11206 @chapter FAQ
11207 @cindex faq
11208 @enumerate
11209 @anchor{faqrtck}
11210 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11211 @cindex RTCK
11212 @cindex adaptive clocking
11213 @*
11214
11215 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11216 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11217 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11218 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11219
11220 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11221 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11222 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11223 @enumerate
11224 @item
11225 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11226 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11227 @item
11228 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11229 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11230 @end enumerate
11231
11232 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11233 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11234 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11235 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11236 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11237 power).
11238
11239 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11240 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11241 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11242 ARM926 scenario).
11243 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11244 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11245 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11246
11247 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11248 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11249 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11250 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11251
11252 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11253
11254 In order to make use of this,
11255 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11256 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11257
11258 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11259 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11260 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11261 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11262 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11263
11264 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11265 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11266 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11267 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11268
11269 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11270 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11271 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11272 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11273 with a CPLD.
11274 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11275 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11276 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11277 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11278 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11279 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11280
11281 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11282
11283 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11284
11285 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11286 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11287 depending on the chips on your board.
11288 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11289 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11290 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11291
11292 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11293 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11294 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11295
11296 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11297 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11298 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11299 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11300
11301 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11302 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11303 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11304 this way.
11305
11306 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11307 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11308 clock rate.
11309 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11310 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11311 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11312
11313 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11314
11315 @example
11316 # Example: 1.234MHz
11317 adapter speed 1234
11318 @end example
11319
11320
11321 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11322
11323 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11324 around Windows filenames.
11325
11326 @example
11327 > echo \a
11328
11329 > echo @{\a@}
11330 \a
11331 > echo "\a"
11332
11333 >
11334 @end example
11335
11336
11337 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11338
11339 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11340 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11341 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11342
11343 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11344 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11345 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11346
11347 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11348 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11349 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11350
11351 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11352
11353 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11354 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11355 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11356 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11357
11358 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11359 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11360 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11361
11362 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11363 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11364
11365 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11366 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11367 memory read caused data abort".
11368
11369 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11370 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11371 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11372 be done, feel free to add this here.
11373
11374 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11375 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11376 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11377 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11378 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11379 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11380 gracefully stops.
11381
11382 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11383 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11384 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11385
11386 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11387 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
11388 bytes. Painful...
11389
11390
11391 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11392 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11393
11394 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11395 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11396 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11397 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11398 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11399 reset, everything else should work fine.
11400
11401 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11402 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11403 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11404 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11405
11406 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11407 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11408 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11409 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11410
11411 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11412
11413 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11414 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11415 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11416
11417 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11418 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11419
11420 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11421 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11422 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11423 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11424 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11425 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11426 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11427 clock frequency?
11428
11429 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11430 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11431 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11432 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11433 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11434
11435 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11436
11437 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11438 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11439 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11440 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11441 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11442 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11443 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11444
11445 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11446
11447 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11448 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11449 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11450 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11451
11452 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11453 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11454 particular order?
11455
11456 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11457 the same order used by the hardware.
11458
11459 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11460 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11461 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11462 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11463 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11464 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11465
11466 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11467 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11468 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11469 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11470
11471 @itemize @bullet
11472 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11473 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11474 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11475 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11476 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11477 @end itemize
11478
11479 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11480
11481 @itemize @bullet
11482 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11483 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11484 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11485 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11486 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11487 @end itemize
11488
11489
11490 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11491 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11492 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11493
11494 TODO.
11495
11496 @end enumerate
11497
11498 @node Tcl Crash Course
11499 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11500 @cindex Tcl
11501
11502 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11503 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11504 how the Tcl scripts work.
11505
11506 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11507 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11508 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11509 OpenOCD.
11510
11511 @section Tcl Rule #1
11512 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11513 @enumerate
11514 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11515 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11516 @end enumerate
11517
11518 The Tcl equal is this:
11519
11520 @enumerate
11521 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11522 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11523 @end enumerate
11524
11525 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11526 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11527
11528 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11529 There is a second pair of rules.
11530 @enumerate
11531 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11532 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11533 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11534 in Tcl.
11535 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11536 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11537 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11538 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11539 @end enumerate
11540
11541 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11542 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11543 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11544 Everything is a string}
11545
11546 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11547 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11548 difference is subtle.
11549 @enumerate
11550 @item Parse Time
11551 @item Evaluation Time
11552 @end enumerate
11553
11554 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11555 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11556 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11557
11558 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11559 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11560 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11561 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11562
11563 @itemize @bullet
11564 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11565 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11566 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11567 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11568 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11569 @example
11570 # bash example
11571 X=`date`
11572 echo "The Date is: $X"
11573 # Tcl example
11574 set X [date]
11575 puts "The Date is: $X"
11576 @end example
11577 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11578 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11579 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11580 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11581 is a string}
11582 @example
11583 set x "Dinner"
11584 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11585 @end example
11586 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11587 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11588 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11589 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11590 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11591 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11592 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11593 @end itemize
11594
11595 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11596
11597 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11598
11599 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11600
11601 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11602 the normal way.
11603
11604 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11605 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11606 line is immediately executed.
11607
11608 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11609 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11610
11611 @subsection Command Execution
11612
11613 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11614 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11615 control flow operators.
11616
11617 Commands are executed like this:
11618
11619 @enumerate
11620 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11621 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11622 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11623 @end enumerate
11624
11625 It sort of works like this:
11626 @example
11627 for(;;)@{
11628 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11629
11630 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11631
11632 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11633 @}
11634 @end example
11635
11636 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11637 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11638 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11639 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11640 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11641 ``LookupCommand()''
11642
11643 @subsection The FOR command
11644
11645 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11646 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11647 command just like any other command.
11648
11649 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11650 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11651 are:
11652
11653 @enumerate 0
11654 @item The ascii text 'for'
11655 @item The start text
11656 @item The test expression
11657 @item The next text
11658 @item The body text
11659 @end enumerate
11660
11661 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11662 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11663 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11664 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11665
11666 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11667 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11668
11669 @example
11670 int
11671 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11672 int *argc,
11673 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11674 @end example
11675
11676 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11677 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11678 still operates in the same basic way.
11679
11680 @subsection FOR command implementation
11681
11682 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11683 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11684
11685 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11686
11687 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11688
11689 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11690 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11691 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11692
11693 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11694 expression and returns a value.
11695
11696 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11697 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11698 @example
11699 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11700
11701 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11702
11703 int
11704 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11705 int argc,
11706 char **argv )
11707 @{
11708 if( argc != 5 )@{
11709 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11710 return ERROR;
11711 @}
11712
11713 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11714
11715 // Execute the start statement.
11716 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11717
11718 // Top of loop test
11719 for(;;)@{
11720 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11721 if( i == 0 )
11722 break;
11723
11724 // Execute the body
11725 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11726
11727 // Execute the LOOP part
11728 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11729 @}
11730
11731 // Return no error
11732 SetResult( interp, "" );
11733 return SUCCESS;
11734 @}
11735 @end example
11736
11737 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11738 in the same basic way.
11739
11740 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11741
11742 @subsection source and find commands
11743 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11744 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11745 @*Remember the parsing rules
11746 @enumerate
11747 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11748 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11749 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11750 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11751 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11752 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11753 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11754 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11755 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11756 @end enumerate
11757 @subsection format command
11758 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11759 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11760 @b{sprintf()}.
11761 @b{Example}
11762 @example
11763 set x 6
11764 set y 7
11765 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11766 @end example
11767 @enumerate
11768 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11769 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11770 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11771 @* Refer to Rule #1
11772 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11773 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11774 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11775 @end enumerate
11776 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11777 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11778 @example
11779 #1 Good
11780 proc someproc @{@} @{
11781 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11782 @}
11783 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11784 #2 Good - no variables
11785 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11786 #3 Good Curly Braces
11787 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11788 puts "Time: [date]"
11789 @}
11790 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11791 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11792 @end example
11793 @enumerate
11794 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11795 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11796 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11797 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11798 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11799 command.
11800 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11801 @*There are 4 examples:
11802 @enumerate
11803 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11804 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11805 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11806 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11807 @end enumerate
11808
11809 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11810 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11811 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11812
11813 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11814 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11815 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11816 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11817 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11818 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11819 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11820 @end enumerate
11821 @subsection Global Variables
11822 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11823 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11824 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11825 @example
11826 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11827 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11828 global x #Global variable X
11829 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11830 @}
11831 @end example
11832 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11833 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11834 @example
11835 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11836 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11837 # Create var name
11838 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11839 # Make it a global
11840 global $vn
11841 # Set it.
11842 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11843 @}
11844 @end example
11845 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11846 @example
11847 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11848 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11849 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11850 @}
11851 @end example
11852
11853 @include fdl.texi
11854
11855 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11856 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11857 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11858 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11859 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11860 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11861
11862 @printindex cp
11863
11864 @node Command and Driver Index
11865 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11866 @printindex fn
11867
11868 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)